blob: 86003f557216d3e016a4c455e0c7f37386b82751 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +0200590 - no-unused-socket
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200591 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200592 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200593 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - tune.buffers.limit
595 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200596 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200597 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100598 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100599 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200600 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100601 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100603 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.session-timeout
605 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200606 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100607 - tune.maxaccept
608 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200609 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200610 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200611 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.rcvbuf.client
613 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100614 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100615 - tune.sndbuf.client
616 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100617 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200619 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200621 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200622 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100623 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100625 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
627 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
628 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100629 - tune.zlib.memlevel
630 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632 * Debugging
633 - debug
634 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635
636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006373.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638------------------------------------
639
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200640ca-base <dir>
641 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200642 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
643 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645chroot <jail dir>
646 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
647 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
648 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
649 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
650 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
651 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100652
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100653cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
654 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
655 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
656 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100657 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
658 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
659 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
660 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
661 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
662 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
663 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
664 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
665 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
666 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100667
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200668crt-base <dir>
669 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
670 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
671 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673daemon
674 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
675 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
676 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
677
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200678deviceatlas-json-file <path>
679 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
680 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
681
682deviceatlas-log-level <value>
683 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
684 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
685
686deviceatlas-separator <char>
687 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
688 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
689
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100690deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200691 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
692 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
693 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100694
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900695external-check
696 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
697 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
698 See "option external-check".
699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700gid <number>
701 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
702 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
703 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100704 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
705 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100707
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100708hard-stop-after <time>
709 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
710
711 Arguments :
712 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
713 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
714 SIGUSR1 signal.
715
716 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
717 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
718 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
719
720 Example:
721 global
722 hard-stop-after 30s
723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724group <group name>
725 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
726 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100727
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200728log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
730 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100731 configured with "log global".
732
733 <address> can be one of:
734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100735 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100736 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
737 port).
738
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100739 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
740 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
741 port).
742
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100743 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
744 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
745 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
746 writeable).
747
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200748 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
749 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100750
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200751 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
752 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
753 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
754 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
755 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
756 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
757 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
758 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
759 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
760 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
761 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
762
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200763 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
764 one of the following :
765
766 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
767 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
768
769 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
771
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100772 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
774 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
775 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
776 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
777
778 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200779 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
780 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
781 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
782 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
783 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
784 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200785
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200786 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100788log-send-hostname [<string>]
789 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
790 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
791 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
792 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
793 the logs.
794
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000795log-tag <string>
796 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
797 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
798 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100799 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000800
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100801lua-load <file>
802 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
803 used multiple times.
804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805nbproc <number>
806 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
807 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
808 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
809 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
810 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
811
812pidfile <pidfile>
813 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
814 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
815 starting the process. See also "daemon".
816
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100817presetenv <name> <value>
818 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
819 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
820 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
821 and "unsetenv".
822
823resetenv [<name> ...]
824 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
825 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
826 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
827 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
828 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
829 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
830 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
831 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
832
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100833stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200834 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
835 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
836 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
837 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
838 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
839 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100840 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200841 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
842 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200843
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200844server-state-base <directory>
845 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200846 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
847 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200848
849server-state-file <file>
850 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
851 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
852 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
853 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
854 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
855 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
856 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
857 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200858 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
859 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200860
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100861setenv <name> <value>
862 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
863 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
864 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
865 and "unsetenv".
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
869 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
872 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
873 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
874 "bind" keyword for more information.
875
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100876ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
878 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
879 keyword to see available options.
880
881 Example:
882 global
883 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
884
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100885ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
887 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300888 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100889 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
890 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
891 information.
892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100893ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
896 keyword to see available options.
897
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200898ssl-dh-param-file <file>
899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
900 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
901 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
902 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
903 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200904 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
905 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
906 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
907 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200908 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
909 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
910 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
911
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100912ssl-server-verify [none|required]
913 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
914 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
915 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
916
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200917stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
918 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
919 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
920 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200921 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
922 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200923
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200924 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
925 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
926 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927
928stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
929 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
930 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100931 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932
933stats maxconn <connections>
934 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
935 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937uid <number>
938 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
939 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
940 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
941 one. See also "gid" and "user".
942
943ulimit-n <number>
944 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
945 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
946 option.
947
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100948unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
949 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
950
951 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
952 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
953 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
954 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
955 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
956 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
957 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
958 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
959 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
960 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
961
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100962unsetenv [<name> ...]
963 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
964 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
965 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
966 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
967 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
968 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
969 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
970
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971user <user name>
972 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
973 See also "uid" and "group".
974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200975node <name>
976 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
977
978 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
979 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
980 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
981 traffic.
982
983description <text>
984 Add a text that describes the instance.
985
986 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
987 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
988 "<" and ">" characters.
989
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010099051degrees-data-file <file path>
991 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
992 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
993
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100995 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
996
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100998 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
999 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1000 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1001
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001002 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001003 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1004
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001006 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1007 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1008
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001009 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1010 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1011
101251degrees-cache-size <number>
1013 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1014 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1015 By default, this cache is disabled.
1016
1017 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1019
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001020wurfl-data-file <file path>
1021 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1022 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1023
1024 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1025 with USE_WURFL=1.
1026
1027wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1028 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1029 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1030 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1031
1032 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1033
1034 Valid WURFL properties are:
1035 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1036
1037 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1038 device.
1039
1040 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1041 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1044 particular web request.
1045
1046 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1047 used Libwurfl API version.
1048
1049 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1050 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1051 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1052
1053 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1054 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1055
1056 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1057 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1058
1059 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1060
1061 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1062
1063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1064 with USE_WURFL=1.
1065
1066wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1067 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1068 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1074 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1075 thus before the chroot.
1076
1077 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1078 with USE_WURFL=1.
1079
1080wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1081 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1082 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1083 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1084 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1085 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1086 mode is enabled by default.
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
1091wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1092 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1093 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1094 - "0" : no cache is used.
1095 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1096 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1097 the highest performing option.
1098
1099 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1100 with USE_WURFL=1.
1101
1102wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1103 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1104 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1105
1106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1107 with USE_WURFL=1.
1108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111-----------------------
1112
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001113max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1114 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1115 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1116 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1117 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1118 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1119 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1120 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1121 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123maxconn <number>
1124 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1125 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1126 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001127 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1128 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1129 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1130 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001131 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1132 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1133 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1134 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1135 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001137maxconnrate <number>
1138 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1139 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1140 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1141 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1142 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1143 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1144 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1145 fairness.
1146
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001147maxcomprate <number>
1148 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001149 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001150 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1151 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1152 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1153 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1154 default value.
1155
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001156maxcompcpuusage <number>
1157 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1158 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1159 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1160 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1161 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1162 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1163 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1164 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1165
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001166maxpipes <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1168 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1169 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1170 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1171 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1172 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1173
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001174maxsessrate <number>
1175 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1176 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1177 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1178 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1179 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1180 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1181 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1182 fairness.
1183
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001184maxsslconn <number>
1185 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1186 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1187 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1188 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1189 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1190 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1191 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001192 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1193 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1194 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1195 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1196 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1197 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1198 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001199
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001200maxsslrate <number>
1201 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1202 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1203 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1204 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1205 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1206 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1207 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1208 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1209 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1210 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1211
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001212maxzlibmem <number>
1213 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1214 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1215 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001216 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1217 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1218 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001220noepoll
1221 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1222 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001223 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001224
1225nokqueue
1226 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1227 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1228 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1229
1230nopoll
1231 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1232 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001234 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001235
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001236nosplice
1237 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1238 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1239 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001240 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001241 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1242 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1243 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1244 "option splice-response".
1245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001246nogetaddrinfo
1247 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1248 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1249
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001250noreuseport
1251 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1252 command line argument "-dR".
1253
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +02001254no-unused-socket
1255 By default, each haproxy process keeps all sockets opened, event those that
1256 are only used by another processes, so that any process can provide all the
1257 sockets, to make reloads seamless. This option disables this, and close all
1258 unused sockets, to save some file descriptors.
1259
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001261 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1262 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1263 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1264 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1265 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1266 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001267
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001268tune.buffers.limit <number>
1269 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1270 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1271 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1272 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1273 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1274 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1275 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1276 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1277 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1278 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1279 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1280 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1281 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1282 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1283 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1284
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001285tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1286 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1287 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1288 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1289 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1290
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001291tune.bufsize <number>
1292 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1293 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1294 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1295 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1296 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1297 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1298 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1299 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001300 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1301 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1302 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001303
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001304tune.chksize <number>
1305 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1306 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1307 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1308 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1309 checks whenever possible.
1310
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001311tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1312 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1313 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1314 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1315 this value. The default value is 1.
1316
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001317tune.http.cookielen <number>
1318 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1319 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1320 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1321 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1322 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1323 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1324 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1325 to change this value.
1326
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001327tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1328 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1329 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1330 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1331 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1332 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1333 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1334 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1335 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1336 limit too high.
1337
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001338tune.idletimer <timeout>
1339 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1340 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1341 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1342 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1343 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1344 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1345 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1346 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1347 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001349tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1350 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001351 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001352 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1353 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1354 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1355 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1356 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1357
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001358tune.lua.maxmem
1359 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1360 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1361 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1362 memory.
1363
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001364tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1365 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001366 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1367 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1368 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001369
1370tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1371 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1372 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1373 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1374 check servers.
1375
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001376tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1377 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1378 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1379 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1380 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1381
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001382tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001383 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1384 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1385 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1386 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1387 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1388 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1389 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1390 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1391 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1392 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001393
1394tune.maxpollevents <number>
1395 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1396 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1397 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1398 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1399 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1400
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001401tune.maxrewrite <number>
1402 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1403 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1404 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1405 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1406 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1407 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1408 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1409 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1410 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1411 bufsize.
1412
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001413tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1414 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1415 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1416 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1417 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1418 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1419 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1420 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1421 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1422 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1423 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1424 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1425 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1426 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1427 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1428 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1429 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1430 setting this parameter to 0.
1431
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001432tune.pipesize <number>
1433 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1434 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1435 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1436 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1437 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1438 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1439
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001440tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1441tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1442 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1443 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1444 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1445 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1446 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1447 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1448 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1449
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001450tune.recv_enough <number>
1451 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1452 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1453 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1454 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1455 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1456
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001457tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1458tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1459 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1460 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1461 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1462 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1463 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1464 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1465 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1466 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1467 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1468 notifying haproxy again.
1469
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001470tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001471 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1472 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1473 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001474 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001475 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1476 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1477 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1478 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1479 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001480 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1481 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001482
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001483tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1484 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1485 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1486 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1487 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1488 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1489 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1490
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001491tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1492 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001493 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001494 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1495 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1496 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1497 being used for too long.
1498
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001499tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1500 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1501 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1502 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1503 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1504 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1505 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1506 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1507 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1508 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1509 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001510 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1511 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001512
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001513tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1514 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1515 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1516 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1517 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1518 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1519 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1520 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001521 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1522 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001523
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001524tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1525 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1526 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1527 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1528 1000 entries.
1529
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001530tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1531 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1532 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1533 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1534
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001535tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001536tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001537tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1538tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1539tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001540 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1541 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1542 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1543 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1544 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1545 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1546 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1547 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001548
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001549 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1550 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1551 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1552 all available space is consumed.
1553 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1554 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1555 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001556
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001557tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1558 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001560 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1561 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1562 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1563
1564tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1565 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1566 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1567 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1568 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015703.3. Debugging
1571--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001572
1573debug
1574 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1575 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1576 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1577 system startup.
1578
1579quiet
1580 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1581 line argument "-q".
1582
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015843.4. Userlists
1585--------------
1586It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1587http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1588it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1589
1590userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001591 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1593
1594group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001595 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001596 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1597 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1598
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001599user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1600 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1602 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001603 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1604 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001605 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001606 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001607
1608
1609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001610 userlist L1
1611 group G1 users tiger,scott
1612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1615 user scott insecure-password elgato
1616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001618 userlist L2
1619 group G1
1620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001625
1626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001628
16293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643
1644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1647
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001648disabled
1649 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1650 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1651 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1652
1653enable
1654 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1657 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1658 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1659 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1660 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1661 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1662 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1663
1664 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1665 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1666
1667 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1668 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1669 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1670 across all peers.
1671
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001672 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1673 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001674
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001675 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001676 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001677 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1678 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1679 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001680
1681 backend mybackend
1682 mode tcp
1683 balance roundrobin
1684 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1685 stick on src
1686
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001687 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1688 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001689
1690
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016913.6. Mailers
1692------------
1693It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1694If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1695in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1696
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001697mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001698 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1699 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1700
1701mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1702 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1703
1704 Example:
1705 mailers mymailers
1706 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1707 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1708
1709 backend mybackend
1710 mode tcp
1711 balance roundrobin
1712
1713 email-alert mailers mymailers
1714 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1715 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1716
1717 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1718 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1719
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001720timeout mail <time>
1721 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1722 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1723 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1724 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 mailers mymailers
1728 timeout mail 20s
1729 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017314. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001732----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001735 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 - frontend <name>
1737 - backend <name>
1738 - listen <name>
1739
1740A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1741its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1742section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
1745A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1746connections.
1747
1748A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1749to forward incoming connections.
1750
1751A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1752parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1755'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1756case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1757
1758Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1759logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1760proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1761However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1762name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1763
1764Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1765and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1768modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1769arbitrary criteria.
1770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001771In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1772a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1773the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1774
1775 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1776 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1777 between responses and new requests.
1778
1779 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1780 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1781 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1782 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1783
1784 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1785 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1786 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1787
1788 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1789 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1790 client-facing connection remains open.
1791
1792 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1793 after the end of the response.
1794
1795The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1796frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1797following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1798weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1799
1800 Backend mode
1801
1802 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1803 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1804 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1805 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1806 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1807 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1808 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1809 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1810 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1811 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1812 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1817--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1820limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1821they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1822limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001825and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1826with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1827specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001830 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1831------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1832acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001833appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001834backlog X X X -
1835balance X - X X
1836bind - X X -
1837bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001838block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001839capture cookie - X X -
1840capture request header - X X -
1841capture response header - X X -
1842clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001843compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001844contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1845cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001846declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847default-server X - X X
1848default_backend X X X -
1849description - X X X
1850disabled X X X X
1851dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001852email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001853email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001854email-alert mailers X X X X
1855email-alert myhostname X X X X
1856email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857enabled X X X X
1858errorfile X X X X
1859errorloc X X X X
1860errorloc302 X X X X
1861-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1862errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001863force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001864filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001865fullconn X - X X
1866grace X X X X
1867hash-type X - X X
1868http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001869http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001870http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001871http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001872http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001873http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001874http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001876ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001877load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001878log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001879log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001880log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001881log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001882max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883maxconn X X X -
1884mode X X X X
1885monitor fail - X X -
1886monitor-net X X X -
1887monitor-uri X X X -
1888option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1889option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1890option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1891option allbackups (*) X - X X
1892option checkcache (*) X - X X
1893option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1894option contstats (*) X X X -
1895option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1896option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1897option forceclose (*) X X X X
1898-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1899option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001900option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001901option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001902option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001903option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001904option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001905option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001906option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001907option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1908option httpchk X - X X
1909option httpclose (*) X X X X
1910option httplog X X X X
1911option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001912option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001913option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001914option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001915option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1916option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1917option logasap (*) X X X -
1918option mysql-check X - X X
1919option nolinger (*) X X X X
1920option originalto X X X X
1921option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001922option pgsql-check X - X X
1923option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001924option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001925option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926option smtpchk X - X X
1927option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1928option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1929option splice-request (*) X X X X
1930option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001931option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001932option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1933option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1934-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001935option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1937option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1938option tcpka X X X X
1939option tcplog X X X X
1940option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001941external-check command X - X X
1942external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001943persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1944rate-limit sessions X X X -
1945redirect - X X X
1946redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1947redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1948reqadd - X X X
1949reqallow - X X X
1950reqdel - X X X
1951reqdeny - X X X
1952reqiallow - X X X
1953reqidel - X X X
1954reqideny - X X X
1955reqipass - X X X
1956reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957reqitarpit - X X X
1958reqpass - X X X
1959reqrep - X X X
1960-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961reqtarpit - X X X
1962retries X - X X
1963rspadd - X X X
1964rspdel - X X X
1965rspdeny - X X X
1966rspidel - X X X
1967rspideny - X X X
1968rspirep - X X X
1969rsprep - X X X
1970server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001971server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02001972server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001973source X - X X
1974srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001975stats admin - X X X
1976stats auth X X X X
1977stats enable X X X X
1978stats hide-version X X X X
1979stats http-request - X X X
1980stats realm X X X X
1981stats refresh X X X X
1982stats scope X X X X
1983stats show-desc X X X X
1984stats show-legends X X X X
1985stats show-node X X X X
1986stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1988stick match - - X X
1989stick on - - X X
1990stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001991stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01001992stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001993tcp-check connect - - X X
1994tcp-check expect - - X X
1995tcp-check send - - X X
1996tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001997tcp-request connection - X X -
1998tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001999tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002000tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002001tcp-response content - - X X
2002tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002003timeout check X - X X
2004timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002005timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002006timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2007timeout connect X - X X
2008timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2009timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2010timeout http-request X X X X
2011timeout queue X - X X
2012timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002013timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2015timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002016timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002017transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002018unique-id-format X X X -
2019unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002020use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002021use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2023 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020264.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2027---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
2029This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2030
2031
2032acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2033 Declare or complete an access list.
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 no | yes | yes | yes
2036 Example:
2037 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2038 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2039 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002041 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
2043
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002044appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2045 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 no | no | yes | yes
2049 Arguments :
2050 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2051 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2052
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002053 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 checked in each cookie value.
2055
2056 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2057 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2058 milliseconds.
2059
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002060 request-learn
2061 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2062 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2063 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2064 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2065 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2066 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2067
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002068 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2069 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2070 data following this prefix.
2071
2072 Example :
2073 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2074
2075 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2076 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2077
2078 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2079 2 modes are currently supported :
2080 - path-parameters :
2081 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2082 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2083 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2084 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2085 - query-string :
2086 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2087 query string.
2088
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002089 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2090 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2091 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002093 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2094 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
2096
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002097backlog <conns>
2098 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2100 yes | yes | yes | no
2101 Arguments :
2102 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2103 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002104 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002105
2106 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2107 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2108 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2109 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2110 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2111 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2112 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2113 backlog parameter.
2114
2115 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2116 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2117 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2118
2119 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2120
2121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002123balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | no | yes | yes
2127 Arguments :
2128 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2129 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2130 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2131 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2132
2133 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2134 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2135 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2136 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002137 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002138 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002139 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2140 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2141 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2142 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2143 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2144 it, so that you don't worry.
2145
2146 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2147 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2148 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2149 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2150 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2151 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2152 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2153 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002155 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2156 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2157 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2158 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2159 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2160 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2161 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2162 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2163
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002164 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002165 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002166 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2167 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002168 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002169 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2170 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2171 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2172 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2173 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002174 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2175 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2176 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2177 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2178 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2179 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2182 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2183 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2184 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2185 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2186 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2187 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2188 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002189 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002191 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2192 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2193 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002195 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2196 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2197 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2198 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2199 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2200 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2201 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2202 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2203 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2204 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2205 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2206 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002208 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002209 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2210 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2211 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2212 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2213 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2214 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2215 URIs start with a leading "/".
2216
2217 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2218 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2219 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2220 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002223 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2224
2225 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002226 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2227 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002228 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2229 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2230 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2231 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002232 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002233 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2234 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002235
2236 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2237 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2238 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2239 server will receive the request.
2240
2241 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2242 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2243 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2244 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2245 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2247 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2248 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002250 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2251 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2252 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2253 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2254 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002256 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002257 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2258 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2259 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2260
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002261 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2262 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2263 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2264
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002265 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002266 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002267 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2268 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2269 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2270 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2271 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2272 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002274 used instead.
2275
2276 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2277 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2278 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2279 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2280
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002281 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2282 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2283 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2284
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002285 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002287 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002288 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2289 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002291 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2292 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2293 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002294
2295 Examples :
2296 balance roundrobin
2297 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002298 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002299 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2300 balance hdr(host)
2301 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002302
2303 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2304 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002306 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002307 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2308 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2309 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2310 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2311
2312 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2313 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2314 defaults to 16 kB.
2315
2316 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2317 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2318
2319 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2320 Round Robin.
2321
2322 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2323 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2324 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2325 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2326
2327 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2328
2329 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002330 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002331 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2332 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2333 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002335 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
2337
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002338bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2339bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2342 no | yes | yes | no
2343 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002344 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2345 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2346 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2347 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002348 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002349 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2350 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2351 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2352 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2353 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2354 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2355 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002356 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2357 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2358 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2359 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2360 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2361 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2362 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002363 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2364 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2365 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002366 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2367 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2368 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002369
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002370 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2371 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002372 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2373 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2374 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002375 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2376 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2377 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2378 the range.
2379
2380 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2381 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2382 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2383 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2384 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2385 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2386 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002387 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002388 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002390 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2391 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2392 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2393 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2394 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2395 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2396 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2397 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002399 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2400 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2401 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2402 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2405 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2406 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2407 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2408 in a frontend.
2409
2410 Example :
2411 listen http_proxy
2412 bind :80,:443
2413 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002414 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002416 listen http_https_proxy
2417 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002418 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002419
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002420 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2421 bind ipv6@:80
2422 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2423 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2424
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002425 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002426 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002427
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002428 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2429 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2430 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2431 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2432 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2433
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002434 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002435 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002438bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002439 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2441 yes | yes | yes | yes
2442 Arguments :
2443 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2444 may be used to override a default value.
2445
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002446 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002447 option may be combined with other numbers.
2448
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002449 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002450 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2451 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2452 missing from all processes.
2453
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002454 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002455 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002456 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2457 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2458 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2459 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002460
2461 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2462 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2463 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2464 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2465 and 'even' instances.
2466
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002467 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2468 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2469 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2470 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002471
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002472 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2473 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2474
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002475 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2476 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2477 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2478
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002479 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2480 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2481
2482 Example :
2483 listen app_ip1
2484 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002485 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486
2487 listen app_ip2
2488 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002489 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002490
2491 listen management
2492 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002493 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002494
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002495 listen management
2496 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2497 bind-process 1-4
2498
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002499 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002500
2501
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002502block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2505 no | yes | yes | yes
2506
2507 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2508 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002509 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002510 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002512 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2513 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2514 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002516 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2517 "http-request deny" instead.
2518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 Example:
2520 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2521 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2522 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002523 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2524 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2525 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002527 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2528 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2529 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002530
2531capture cookie <name> len <length>
2532 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
2536 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2537 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2538 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2539 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2540 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2541
2542 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2543 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2544 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2545 right if it exceeds <length>.
2546
2547 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2548 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2549 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2550 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2551
2552 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2553 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2554 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2555
2556 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2557 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2558 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002559 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2560 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2561 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
2563 Example:
2564 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2565
2566 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568
2569
2570capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002571 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2573 no | yes | yes | no
2574 Arguments :
2575 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002576 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2578 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2579 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2580
2581 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2582 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2583 it exceeds <length>.
2584
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002585 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2587 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002588 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2589 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2590 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2591 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002592 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002593 environments to find where the request came from.
2594
2595 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2596 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2597 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2598 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002600 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2601 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2602 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2603 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2604 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
2606 Example:
2607 capture request header Host len 15
2608 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002609 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002611 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612 about logging.
2613
2614
2615capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002616 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2618 no | yes | yes | no
2619 Arguments :
2620 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002621 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2623 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2624 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2625
2626 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2627 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2628 it exceeds <length>.
2629
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002630 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2632 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2633 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002634 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2635 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2636 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2637 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002639 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2640 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2641 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2642 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2643 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
2645 Example:
2646 capture response header Content-length len 9
2647 capture response header Location len 15
2648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002649 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650 about logging.
2651
2652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002653clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | yes | yes | no
2657 Arguments :
2658 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2659 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2660 as explained at the top of this document.
2661
2662 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2663 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2664 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2665 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2666 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2667 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2668 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2669 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002670 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002671 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2672 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2673
2674 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2675 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2676 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2677 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2678 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2679 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2680
2681 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2682 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2683
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002684 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2685 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002687compression algo <algorithm> ...
2688compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002689compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002690 Enable HTTP compression.
2691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2692 yes | yes | yes | yes
2693 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002694 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2695 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2696 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2697
2698 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002699 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2700 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2701 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002702
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002703 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002704 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002705
2706 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2707 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2708 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2709 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2710 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002711 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002712
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002713 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2714 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2715 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2716 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2717 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2718 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2719 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002720 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002721
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002722 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002723 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002724 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2725 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2726 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2727 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2728 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002729
2730 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2731 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2732 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2733 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2734 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002735 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2736 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2737 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2738 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2739 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002740 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2741 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002742
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002743 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002744 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2745 "Accept-Encoding" header
2746 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002747 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002748 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2749 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002750 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2751 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2752 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2753 "multipart"
2754 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2755 header
2756 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2757 and later
2758 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2759 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002760
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002761 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2762 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002763
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002764 Examples :
2765 compression algo gzip
2766 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002769contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 yes | no | yes | yes
2773 Arguments :
2774 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2776 as explained at the top of this document.
2777
2778 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002779 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002780 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2782 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2783 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2784 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2785
2786 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2792
2793 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2794 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2795 instead.
2796
2797 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2798 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2799
2800
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002801cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002802 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2803 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002804 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 yes | no | yes | yes
2808 Arguments :
2809 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2810 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2811 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2812 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2813 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2814 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2815 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2816 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2817 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2818
2819 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2820 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2821 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2822 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2823 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2824 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002825 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2826 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2827 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2828 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2829 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002832 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002833
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002834 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002835 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2836 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2837 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2838 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2839 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2840 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2841 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2842 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2843 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2844 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
2846 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2847 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2848 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2849 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2850 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2851 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2852 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2853 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2854 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002855 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002856 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2857 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2858 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002860 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2861 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2862 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002863 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2864 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2865 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2866 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002867 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2868 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2869 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
2871 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2872 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2873 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2874 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2875 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2876 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2877 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2878 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2879 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2880
2881 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2882 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2883 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2884 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2885 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2886 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2887 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2888 persistence cookie in the cache.
2889 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2890
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002891 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2892 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2893 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2894 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2895 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2896 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2897 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2898 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2899 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2900 they logout.
2901
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002902 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2903 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2904 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2905 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2906
2907 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2908 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2909 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2910 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2911 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2912 this attribute.
2913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002914 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002915 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002916 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2917 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2918 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2919 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2920 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2921 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002922
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002923 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2924 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2925 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2926 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2927 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2928 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2929 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2930 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2931 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2932 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2933 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2934 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2935 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2936 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2937 the site.
2938
2939 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2940 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2941 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2942 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2943 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2944 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2945 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2946 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2947 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2948 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2949 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2950 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2951 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2952 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2953 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2954 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2955
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002956 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2957 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2958 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2959 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2960 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2961 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2964 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2965 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2966 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 Examples :
2969 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2970 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2971 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002972 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002974 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002976
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002977declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2978 Declares a capture slot.
2979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 no | yes | yes | no
2981 Arguments:
2982 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2983
2984 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2985 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2986 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2987 for use in the response.
2988
2989 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002990 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002991 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2992
2993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002994default-server [param*]
2995 Change default options for a server in a backend
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | no | yes | yes
2998 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002999 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3000 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3001 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3002 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003003
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003004 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003005 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3006
3007 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010default_backend <backend>
3011 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | yes | yes | no
3014 Arguments :
3015 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3016
3017 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3018 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3019 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3020 will catch all undetermined requests.
3021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022 Example :
3023
3024 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3025 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3026 default_backend dynamic
3027
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003028 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003031description <string>
3032 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 no | yes | yes | yes
3035 Arguments : string
3036
3037 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3038 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3039 it describes.
3040 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3041
3042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043disabled
3044 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3046 yes | yes | yes | yes
3047 Arguments : none
3048
3049 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3050 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3051 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3052 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3053 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3054 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3055 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3056
3057 See also : "enabled"
3058
3059
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003060dispatch <address>:<port>
3061 Set a default server address
3062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3063 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003064 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003065
3066 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3067 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3068 during start-up.
3069
3070 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3071 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3072 possible with normal servers.
3073
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003074 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003075 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3076 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3077 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3078 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3079
3080 See also : "server"
3081
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003082
3083dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3084 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 yes | no | yes | yes
3087 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3088
3089 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3090 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3091 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3092 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3093 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3094 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096enabled
3097 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 yes | yes | yes | yes
3100 Arguments : none
3101
3102 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3103 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3104
3105 See also : "disabled"
3106
3107
3108errorfile <code> <file>
3109 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112 Arguments :
3113 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003114 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3115 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
3117 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003118 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003120 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3121 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3124 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3125 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3126
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003127 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3130 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3131 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3132 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3133
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003134 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3135 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3136 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3137 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3138 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3139 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3142 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3143 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003144 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3146
3147 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3148
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003149 Example :
3150 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003151 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003152 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3153 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3154
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003155
3156errorloc <code> <url>
3157errorloc302 <code> <url>
3158 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | yes
3161 Arguments :
3162 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003163 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164
3165 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3166 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3167 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3168 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3169 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3170
3171 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3172 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3173 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3174
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003175 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003177 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3178 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3179 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3180 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003181 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003182 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3183 request.
3184
3185 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3186
3187
3188errorloc303 <code> <url>
3189 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3191 yes | yes | yes | yes
3192 Arguments :
3193 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3194 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3195
3196 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3197 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3198 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3199 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3200 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3201
3202 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3203 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3204 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3205
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003206 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3207
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003208 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3209 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3210 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3211 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003212 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003213
3214 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3215
3216
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003217email-alert from <emailaddr>
3218 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3219 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3221 yes | yes | yes | yes
3222
3223 Arguments :
3224
3225 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3226
3227 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3228 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3229
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003230 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003231 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3232 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003233
3234
3235email-alert level <level>
3236 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3237 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | yes | yes | yes
3240
3241 Arguments :
3242
3243 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3244 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3245 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3246
3247 By default level is alert
3248
3249 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3250 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3251 for the proxy.
3252
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003253 Alerts are sent when :
3254
3255 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3256 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3257 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3258 is notice or lower
3259 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3260 and a health check status update occurs
3261
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003262 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3263 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003264 section 3.6 about mailers.
3265
3266
3267email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3268 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3270 yes | yes | yes | yes
3271
3272 Arguments :
3273
3274 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3275
3276 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3277 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3278
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003279 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3280 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003281
3282
3283email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3284 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3285 mailers.
3286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 yes | yes | yes | yes
3288
3289 Arguments :
3290
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003291 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003292
3293 By default the systems hostname is used.
3294
3295 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3296 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3297 for the proxy.
3298
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003299 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3300 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003301
3302
3303email-alert to <emailaddr>
3304 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3305 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3307 yes | yes | yes | yes
3308
3309 Arguments :
3310
3311 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3312
3313 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3314 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3315
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003316 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003317 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3318
3319
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003320force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3321 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 no | yes | yes | yes
3324
3325 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3326 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3327 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3328 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3329 marked down for maintenance operations.
3330
3331 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3332 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3333 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3334 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3335 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3336 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3337 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3338 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3339 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3340
3341 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3342 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3343 is used.
3344
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003345 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003346 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003347
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003348
3349filter <name> [param*]
3350 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3352 no | yes | yes | yes
3353 Arguments :
3354 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3355 referenced in section 9.
3356
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003357 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003358 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003359 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3360 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003361
3362 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3363 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3364
3365 Example:
3366 listen
3367 bind *:80
3368
3369 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3370 filter compression
3371 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3372
3373 compression algo gzip
3374 compression offload
3375
3376 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3377
3378 See also : section 9.
3379
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381fullconn <conns>
3382 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | no | yes | yes
3385 Arguments :
3386 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3387 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3388
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003389 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003390 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003391 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3393 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3394 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3395 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3396 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003397 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003398
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003399 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3400 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003401 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3402 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3403 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003404
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003405 Example :
3406 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3407 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3408 # connections.
3409 backend dynamic
3410 fullconn 10000
3411 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3412 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3413
3414 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3415
3416
3417grace <time>
3418 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003420 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003421 Arguments :
3422 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3423 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3424 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3425
3426 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3427 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003428 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003429 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3430
3431 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3432 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3433 simplify it.
3434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003436hash-balance-factor <factor>
3437 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | no | no | yes
3440 Arguments :
3441 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3442 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3443 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3444
3445 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3446 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3447 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3448 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3449 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3450 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3451 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3452
3453 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3454 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3455 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3456 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3457 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3458
3459 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3460
3461
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003462hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003463 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | no | yes | yes
3466 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003467 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3468 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003469
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003470 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3471 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3472 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3473 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3474 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3475 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3476 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3477 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3478 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3479 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003480
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003481 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3482 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3483 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3484 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3485 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3486 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3487 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3488 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3489 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3490 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3491 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3492 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3493 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003494 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3495 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003496
3497 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3498
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003499 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003500 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3501 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3502 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003503 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3504 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3505 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003506
3507 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3508 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003509 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3510 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3511 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3512 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3513
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003514 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3515 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3516 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3517 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3518 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3519 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3520 parameter.
3521
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003522 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3523 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3524 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3525 used on strings.
3526
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003527 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3528
3529 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3530 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3531 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3532 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3533 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3534 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3535 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3536 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3537 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3538 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3539 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3540 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003541
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003542 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3543 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3544 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003545
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003546 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003547
3548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549http-check disable-on-404
3550 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003552 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003553 Arguments : none
3554
3555 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3556 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3557 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3558 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3559 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3560 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3561 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3562 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003563 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3564 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3565 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3566
3567 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3568
3569
3570http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003571 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003573 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003574 Arguments :
3575 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3576 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003577 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003578 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3579 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3580 details on the supported keywords.
3581
3582 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3583 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3584 with the usual backslash ('\').
3585
3586 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3587 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3588 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3589 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3590 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3591
3592 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003593 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003594 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3595 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3596 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3597
3598 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003599 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003600 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3601 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3602 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3603 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3604
3605 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003606 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003607 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3608 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3609 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3610 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3611 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3612 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3613 trace).
3614
3615 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003616 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003617 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3618 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3619 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3620 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3621 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3622 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3623
3624 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3625 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3626 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3627 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3628 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3629 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3630 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3631 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3632
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003633 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3634 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3635 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3636
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003637 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3638 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3639
3640 Examples :
3641 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003642 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003643
3644 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003645 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003646
3647 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003648 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003649
3650 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003651 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003653 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654
3655
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003656http-check send-state
3657 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3659 yes | no | yes | yes
3660 Arguments : none
3661
3662 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3663 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3664 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3665 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3666 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3667
3668 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3669 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3670 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3671 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3672 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003673 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3674 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3675 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3676
3677 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3678 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3679 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3680
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003681 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3682 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3683 checked in multiple backends.
3684
3685 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3686 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3687
3688 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3689 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3690 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3691 one fails.
3692
3693 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3694 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3695 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3696
3697 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3698 server's queue.
3699
3700 Example of a header received by the application server :
3701 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3702 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3703
3704 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3705
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003706http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3707 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003708 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003709 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003710 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003711 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3712 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003713 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3714 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003715 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3716 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3717 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003718 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003719 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003720 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003721 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003722 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003723 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003724 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003725 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003727 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3728
3729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 no | yes | yes | yes
3731
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003732 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3733 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3734 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3735 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3736 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003737
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003738 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3739 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3740 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3741
3742 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003743 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3744 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3745 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3746 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003747
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003748 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3749 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3750 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003751 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3752 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003753 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3754 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3755 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3756 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3757 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003758 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003759 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3760 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003761
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003762 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3763 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3764 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3765 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3766 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3767
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003768 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3769 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3770 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003771 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3772 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003773
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003774 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3775 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3776 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3777 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3778 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3779 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3780 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3781 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3782
3783 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3784 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3785 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003786 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3787 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003788
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003789 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3790 <name>.
3791
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003792 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3793 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3794 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3795 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3796 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3797 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3798 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3799 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3800
3801 Example:
3802
3803 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3804
3805 applied to:
3806
3807 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3808
3809 outputs:
3810
3811 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3812
3813 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3814
3815 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3816 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3817 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3818 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3819 header.
3820
3821 Example:
3822
3823 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3824
3825 applied to:
3826
3827 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3828
3829 outputs:
3830
3831 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3832
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003833 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3834 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3835 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3836 it.
3837
3838 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3839 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3840 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3841 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3842 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3843 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3844
3845 Example :
3846 # prepend the host name before the path
3847 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3848
3849 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3850 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3851 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3852 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3853 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3854 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3855 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3856 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3857
3858 Example :
3859 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3860 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3861
3862 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3863 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3864 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3865 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3866 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3867 "set-query".
3868
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003869 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3870 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3871 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3872 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3873 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3874 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3875 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3876 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3877
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003878 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3879 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3880 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3881 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3882 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3883 another equipment.
3884
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003885 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3886 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3887 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3888 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3889 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3890 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3891 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3892 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3893
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003894 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3895 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3896 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3897 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3898 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3899 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3900 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3901 admin privileges.
3902
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003903 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3904 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3905 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3906 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3907 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3908 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3909 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3910 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3911
3912 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3913 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3914 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3915 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3916 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3917 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3918
3919 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3920 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3921 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3922 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3923 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3924 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3925
3926 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3927 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3928 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3929 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3930 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3931 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3932 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3933 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3934 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3935
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003936 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003937 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3938 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3939 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3940 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3941 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3942 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3943 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3944 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3945 request header" for more information.
3946
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003947 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3948 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3949 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3950 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003951 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3952 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003953
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003954 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3955 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3956 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3957 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3958 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3959 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3960 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3961 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3962 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3963 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3964 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3965 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3966
3967 These actions take one or two arguments :
3968 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3969 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3970 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3971 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3972
3973 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3974 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3975 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3976 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3977
3978 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3979 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3980 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3981 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3982 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3983 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3984 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3985 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3986
3987 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3988 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3989 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3990 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3991 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3992
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003993 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3994 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3995 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3996 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3997 continues.
3998
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003999 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4000 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4001 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4002 the actions evaluation continues.
4003
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004004 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4005 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4006 inline.
4007
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004008 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4009 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004010 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004011 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4012 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004013 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004014 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004015 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004016 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4017 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004018 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004019 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004020 and '_'.
4021
4022 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4023 followed by some converters.
4024
4025 Example:
4026
4027 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4028
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004029 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4030 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4031
4032 Example:
4033
4034 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4035
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004036 - set-src <expr> :
4037 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4038 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4039 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4040 source IP for privacy.
4041
4042 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4043 followed by some converters.
4044
4045 Example:
4046
4047 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4048 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4049
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004050 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4051 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004052
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004053 - set-src-port <expr> :
4054 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4055 expression.
4056
4057 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4058 followed by some converters.
4059
4060 Example:
4061
4062 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4063 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4064
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004065 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4066 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4067 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004068
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004069 - set-dst <expr> :
4070 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4071 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4072 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4073 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4074 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4075
4076 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4077 followed by some converters.
4078
4079 Example:
4080
4081 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4082 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4083
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004084 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4085 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4086
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004087 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4088 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4089 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4090 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4091
4092 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4093 followed by some converters.
4094
4095 Example:
4096
4097 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4098 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4099
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004100 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4101 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4102 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4103
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004104 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4105 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4106 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4107 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4108 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4109 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4110 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4111 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4112 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4113 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4114 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4115 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4116 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4117 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4118 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4119 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4120
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004121 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4122
4123 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4124 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004125 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4126 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4127
4128 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4129 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4130 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4131 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004132
4133 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004134 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4135 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4136 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004137
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004138 http-request allow if nagios
4139 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4140 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4141 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004142
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004143 Example:
4144 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004145 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004146
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004147 Example:
4148 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4149 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004150 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4152 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4153 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4154 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4155 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4156 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4157
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004158 Example:
4159 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4160 acl add path /addacl
4161 acl del path /delacl
4162
4163 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4164
4165 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4166 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4167
4168 Example:
4169 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4170 acl setmap path /setmap
4171 acl delmap path /delmap
4172
4173 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4174
4175 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4176 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4177
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004178 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4179 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004180
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004181http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004182 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004183 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004184 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4185 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004186 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004187 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4188 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4189 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4190 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004191 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004192 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004193 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004194 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004195 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004196 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004197 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004198 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004199 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004200 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4201
4202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4203 no | yes | yes | yes
4204
4205 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4206 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4207 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4208 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4209 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4210 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4211
4212 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4213 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4214 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4215 current section.
4216
4217 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4218 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4219 rules are evaluated.
4220
4221 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4222 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4223 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4224 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4225 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4226 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4227 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4228
4229 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4230 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4231 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4232 external users.
4233
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004234 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4235 <name>.
4236
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004237 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4238 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4239 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4240 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4241 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4242 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4243 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4244 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4245
4246 Example:
4247
4248 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4249
4250 applied to:
4251
4252 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4253
4254 outputs:
4255
4256 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4257
4258 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4259
4260 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4261 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4262 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4263 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4264 header.
4265
4266 Example:
4267
4268 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4269
4270 applied to:
4271
4272 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4273
4274 outputs:
4275
4276 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4277
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004278 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004279 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4280 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4281 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004282
4283 Example:
4284
4285 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4286 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004287 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4288 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004289
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004290 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4291 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4292 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4293 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4294 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4295 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4296 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4297 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4298
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004299 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4300 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4301 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4302 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4303 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4304 another equipment.
4305
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004306 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4307 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4308 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4309 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4310 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4311 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4312 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4313 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4314
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004315 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4316 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4317 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4318 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4319 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4320 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4321 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4322 admin privileges.
4323
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004324 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4325 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4326 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4327 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4328 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4329 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4330 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4331 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4332
4333 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4334 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4335 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4336 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4337 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4338 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4339
4340 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4341 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4342 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4343 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4344 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4345 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4346
4347 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4348 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4349 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4350 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4351 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4352 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4353 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4354 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4355 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4356
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004357 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4358 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4359 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4360 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4361 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4362 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4363 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4364 response header" for more information.
4365
4366 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4367 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4368 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4369 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4370 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004371 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4372 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004373
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004374 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4375 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4376 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4377 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4378 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4379 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4380
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004381 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4382 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4383 inline.
4384
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004385 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4386 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004387 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004388 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4389 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004390 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004391 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004392 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004393 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4394 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004396 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4397 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004398
4399 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4400 followed by some converters.
4401
4402 Example:
4403
4404 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4405
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004406 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4407 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4408
4409 Example:
4410
4411 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4412
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004413 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4414 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4415 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4416 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4417 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4418 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4419 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4420
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004421 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4422 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4423 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4424 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4425 continues.
4426
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004427 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4428 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4429 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4430 the actions evaluation continues.
4431
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004432 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4433 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4434 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4435 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4436 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4437 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4438 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4439 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4440 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4441 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4442 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4443 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4444 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4445 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4446 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4447 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4448
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004449 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4450
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004451 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004452 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4453 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004454 rules.
4455
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004456 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4457 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4458 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4459 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4460
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004461 Example:
4462 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4463
4464 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4465
4466 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4467 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4468
4469 Example:
4470 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4471
4472 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4473
4474 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4475 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4476
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004477 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4478 ACL usage.
4479
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004480
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004481http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4482 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4483
4484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 yes | no | yes | yes
4486
4487 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4488 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4489 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4490 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4491 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4492 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4493
4494 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4495
4496 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4497 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4498 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4499 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4500 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4501 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4502 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4503 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4504 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4505 not checking any request past the first one.
4506
4507 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4508 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4509 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4510 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4511 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4512 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4513 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4514
4515 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4516 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4517 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4518 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4519 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4520 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4521 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4522 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4523 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4524 downsides of rare connection failures.
4525
4526 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4527 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4528 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4529 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4530 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4531 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4532 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4533 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4534 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4535 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4536 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4537 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4538
4539 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4540 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4541 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4542 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4543
4544 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4545 and are never shared ;
4546
4547 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4548 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4549 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4550 and are never shared ;
4551
4552 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4553 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4554 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4555
4556 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4557 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4558 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4559
4560 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4561
4562
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004563http-send-name-header [<header>]
4564 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4565
4566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | no | yes | yes
4568
4569 Arguments :
4570
4571 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4572
4573 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4574 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4575 is added with the header string proved.
4576
4577 See also : "server"
4578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004579id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004580 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 no | yes | yes | yes
4583 Arguments : none
4584
4585 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4586 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4587 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004588
4589
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004590ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4591 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 no | yes | yes | yes
4594
4595 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4596 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4597 and running).
4598
4599 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4600 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4601 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004602 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004603 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4604
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004605 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4606 "unless" condition is met.
4607
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004608 Example:
4609 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4610 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4611 ignore-persist if url_static
4612
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004613 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4614
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004615load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4616 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | no | yes | yes
4619
4620 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4621 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4622 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4623 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4624 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4625 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4626 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4627 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4628
4629 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4630 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004631 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004632
4633 Arguments:
4634 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4635 named "server-state-file".
4636
4637 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4638 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4639 name is used as a file name.
4640
4641 none don't load any stat for this backend
4642
4643 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004644 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4645 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4646 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4647 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4648 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004649
4650 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4651 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004653 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004655 global
4656 stats socket /tmp/socket
4657 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004658
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004659 defaults
4660 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004661
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004662 backend bk
4663 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4664 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004665
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004666
4667 Then one can run :
4668
4669 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4670
4671 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4672
4673 1
4674 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4675 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4676 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004678 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004679
4680 global
4681 stats socket /tmp/socket
4682 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4683
4684 defaults
4685 load-server-state-from-file local
4686
4687 backend bk
4688 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4689 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004691
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004692 Then one can run :
4693
4694 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4695
4696 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4697
4698 1
4699 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4700 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4701 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4702
4703 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4704 "show servers state"
4705
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004708log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004709no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004710 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004713
4714 Prefix :
4715 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4716 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4717 prefix does not allow arguments.
4718
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719 Arguments :
4720 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4721 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4722 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4723 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4724 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4725 parameter.
4726
4727 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4728 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4729
4730 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4731 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4732 standard syslog port).
4733
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004734 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4735 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4736 standard syslog port).
4737
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004738 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4739 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4740 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4741 appropriately writeable).
4742
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004743 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4744 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004745
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004746 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4747 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4748 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4749 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4750 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4751 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4752 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4753 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4754 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4755 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4756 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004758 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4759
4760 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4761 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4762 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4763
4764 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4765 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4766 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004767 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4768 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4769 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4770 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4771 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772
4773 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4774
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004775 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4776 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4777 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004778
4779 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4780 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4781 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4782 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4783
4784 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4785 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004786
4787 Example :
4788 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004789 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4790 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004791 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004793
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004794log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004795 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004798
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004799 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4800 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4801 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4802 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4803 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004804
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004805 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4806 "option httplog" directives.
4807
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004808log-format-sd <string>
4809 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | no
4812
4813 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4814 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4815 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4816 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4817 which covers the log format string in depth.
4818
4819 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4820 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4821
4822 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4823 log format to "rfc5424".
4824
4825 Example :
4826 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4827
4828
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004829log-tag <string>
4830 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 yes | yes | yes | yes
4833
4834 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4835 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4836 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4837 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4838 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4839 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4840 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4841 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4842 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004844max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4845 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848
4849 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4850 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4851 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4852 servers.
4853
4854 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4855 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4856 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4857 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4858 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4859 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4860 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4861 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4862 picking a different server.
4863
4864 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4865 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4866 even if they have to be queued.
4867
4868 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4869 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4870
4871
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004872maxconn <conns>
4873 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | yes | yes | no
4876 Arguments :
4877 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4878 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4879 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4880 closes.
4881
4882 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4883 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4884 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4885 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004886 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4887 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4888 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4889 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890
4891 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4892 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4893 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4894
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004895 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4896
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004897 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4898
4899
4900mode { tcp|http|health }
4901 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4903 yes | yes | yes | yes
4904 Arguments :
4905 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4906 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4907 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4908 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4909
4910 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4911 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4912 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4913 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4914 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4915
4916 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004917 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4918 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4919 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4920 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4921 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4922 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4923 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004924
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004925 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4926 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4927 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004929 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930 defaults http_instances
4931 mode http
4932
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004933 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004935
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004936monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4939 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004940 Arguments :
4941 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4942 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004943 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004944 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4945 backend and its backup.
4946
4947 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4948 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4949 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4950 servers in a list of backends.
4951
4952 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4953 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4954 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4955 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4956 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4957 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4958 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004959 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4960 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004961
4962 Example:
4963 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004965 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4966 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4967 monitor-uri /site_alive
4968 monitor fail if site_dead
4969
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004970 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004971
4972
4973monitor-net <source>
4974 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4976 yes | yes | yes | no
4977 Arguments :
4978 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4979 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4980 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4981 followed by a mask.
4982
4983 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4984 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004985 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004986 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4987
4988 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4989 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4990 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4991 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004992 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4993 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4994 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004996 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4997 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4998 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4999 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5000 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5001 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005002
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005003 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5004 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005005
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005006 Example :
5007 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5008 frontend www
5009 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5010
5011 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5012
5013
5014monitor-uri <uri>
5015 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | no
5018 Arguments :
5019 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5020 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5021
5022 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5023 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5024 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5025 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5026 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5027 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5028 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5029 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5030
5031 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5032 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5033 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5034 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5035 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5036 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5037
5038 Example :
5039 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5040 frontend www
5041 mode http
5042 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5043
5044 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005046
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005047option abortonclose
5048no option abortonclose
5049 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5051 yes | no | yes | yes
5052 Arguments : none
5053
5054 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5055 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5056 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5057 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005058 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005059 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5060 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5061 encountered while delivering the response.
5062
5063 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5064 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5065 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5066 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5067 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5068 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005069 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005070 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005071 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005072 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5073 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5074 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5075
5076 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5077 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5078 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5079 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5080 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5081 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5082 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5083 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005084 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005085
5086 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5087 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5088
5089 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5090
5091
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005092option accept-invalid-http-request
5093no option accept-invalid-http-request
5094 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | no
5097 Arguments : none
5098
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005099 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005100 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5101 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5102 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5103 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5104 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5105 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5106 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005107 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5108 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5109 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5110 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5111 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005112 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005113 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5114 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5115 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005116
5117 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5118 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5119 been confirmed.
5120
5121 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5122 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005123 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5124 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005125 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5126
5127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5129
5130 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5131 stats socket.
5132
5133
5134option accept-invalid-http-response
5135no option accept-invalid-http-response
5136 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments : none
5140
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005141 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005142 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5143 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5144 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5145 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5146 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5147 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5148 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005149 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5150 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5151 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005152
5153 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5154 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5155 been confirmed.
5156
5157 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5158 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5159 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5160 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5161
5162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5164
5165 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5166 stats socket.
5167
5168
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005169option allbackups
5170no option allbackups
5171 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5173 yes | no | yes | yes
5174 Arguments : none
5175
5176 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5177 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5178 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5179 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5180 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5181 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5182 order between the backup servers anymore.
5183
5184 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5185 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5186
5187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5189
5190
5191option checkcache
5192no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005193 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | yes | yes
5196 Arguments : none
5197
5198 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5199 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005200 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005201 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5202 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005203 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005204
5205 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005206 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005207 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005208 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5209 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005210 to the client are :
5211 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005212 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005213 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005214 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5215 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5216 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5217 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5218 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5219 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5220 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5221 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5222 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5223 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5224 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5225
5226 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005227 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005228 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005229 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005230 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5231
5232 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5233 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005234 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005235 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5236
5237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5239
5240
5241option clitcpka
5242no option clitcpka
5243 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5245 yes | yes | yes | no
5246 Arguments : none
5247
5248 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5249 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5250 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5251 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5252
5253 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5254 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5255 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5256 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5257
5258 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5259 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5260 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5261 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5262 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5263
5264 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5265
5266 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5267 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5268 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5269
5270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5272
5273 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5274
5275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005276option contstats
5277 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | yes | yes | no
5280 Arguments : none
5281
5282 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5283 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5284 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5285 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005286 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5287 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5288 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5289 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5290 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005291
5292
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005293option dontlog-normal
5294no option dontlog-normal
5295 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5297 yes | yes | yes | no
5298 Arguments : none
5299
5300 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5301 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5302 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5303 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5304 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5305 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5306 logged.
5307
5308 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5309 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5310 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005312 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005313 logging.
5314
5315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005316option dontlognull
5317no option dontlognull
5318 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | yes | yes | no
5321 Arguments : none
5322
5323 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5324 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5325 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5326 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5327 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5328 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005329 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5330 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5331 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005332
5333 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5334 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5335 would not be logged.
5336
5337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5339
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005340 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5341 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005342
5343
5344option forceclose
5345no option forceclose
5346 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005348 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005349 Arguments : none
5350
5351 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5352 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5353 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5354 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5355 global session times in the logs.
5356
5357 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005358 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005359 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005360
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005361 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5362 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5363 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5364
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005365 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5366 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005367
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5370
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005371 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005372
5373
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005374option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005375 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | yes | yes | yes
5378 Arguments :
5379 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5380 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005381 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005382 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005383
5384 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5385 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5386 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5387 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5388 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5389 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5390 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005391 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5392 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5393 possible that the client has already brought one.
5394
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005395 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005396 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005397 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5398 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005399 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5400 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005401
5402 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5403 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5404 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5405 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5406 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5407 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5408 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5409
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005410 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5411 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5412 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5413 are under the control of the end-user.
5414
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005415 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005416 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5417 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005418 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5419 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5420 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005421
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005422 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005423 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5424 frontend www
5425 mode http
5426 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5427
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005428 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5429 backend www
5430 mode http
5431 option forwardfor header X-Client
5432
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005433 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005434 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005435
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005436
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005437option http-buffer-request
5438no option http-buffer-request
5439 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | yes | yes | yes
5442 Arguments : none
5443
5444 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5445 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5446 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5447 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5448 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5449 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5450 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5451 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005452 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005453 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5454 default.
5455
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005456 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005457
5458
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005459option http-ignore-probes
5460no option http-ignore-probes
5461 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | yes | yes | no
5464 Arguments : none
5465
5466 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5467 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5468 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5469 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5470 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5471 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5472 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5473 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5474 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5475 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5476 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5477 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5478
5479 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5480 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5481 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5482 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5483 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5484 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5485 are often the only way to detect them.
5486
5487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5489
5490 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5491
5492
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005493option http-keep-alive
5494no option http-keep-alive
5495 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | yes | yes | yes
5498 Arguments : none
5499
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005500 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5501 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5502 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5503 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5504 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5505 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5506 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5507
5508 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5509 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005510 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5511 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5512 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5513 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5514 situations where this option may be useful :
5515
5516 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5517 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5518
5519 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5520 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5521
5522 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5523 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5524 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5525 request.
5526
5527 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5528 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005529 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5530 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5531 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005532
5533 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5534 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5535
5536 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5537 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5538 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5539 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5540 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5541 not set.
5542
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005543 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5544 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005545 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005546 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005547
5548 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005549 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5550 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005551
5552
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005553option http-no-delay
5554no option http-no-delay
5555 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 yes | yes | yes | yes
5558 Arguments : none
5559
5560 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5561 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5562 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5563 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5564 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5565 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5566 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5567 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5568 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5569 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5570 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5571 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5572 affected.
5573
5574 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5575 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5576 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5577 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5578 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5579 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5580 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5581 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5582 latency environments.
5583
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005584 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5585
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005586
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005587option http-pretend-keepalive
5588no option http-pretend-keepalive
5589 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5591 yes | yes | yes | yes
5592 Arguments : none
5593
5594 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5595 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5596 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5597 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5598 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5599 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5600 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5601 consider the response complete.
5602
5603 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5604 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5605 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5606 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5607 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5608 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5609
5610 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5611 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5612 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5613 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5614 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5615 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5616 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5617
5618 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5619 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005620 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005621 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5622 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005623
5624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5626
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005627 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5628 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005629
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005630
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005631option http-server-close
5632no option http-server-close
5633 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 yes | yes | yes | yes
5636 Arguments : none
5637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005638 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5639 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5640 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5641 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5642 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5643 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5644 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5645 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5646 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5647 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5648 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5649 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5650 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5651 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5652 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5653 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005654
5655 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5656 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5657 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5658 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005659 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5660 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005661
5662 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5663 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005664 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5665 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005666 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5667 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005668
5669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5671
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005672 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005673 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5674 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005675
5676
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005677option http-tunnel
5678no option http-tunnel
5679 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5681 yes | yes | yes | yes
5682 Arguments : none
5683
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005684 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5685 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5686 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5687 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5688 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5689 "option http-tunnel".
5690
5691 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005692 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005693 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5694 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5695 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5696 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5697 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5698 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5699 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005700
5701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5703
5704 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5705 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5706 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5707
5708
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005709option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005710no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005711 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | yes | yes | no
5714 Arguments : none
5715
5716 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5717 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5718 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5719 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5720 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5721 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5722 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5723
5724 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5725 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005726 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5727 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5728 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005729
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005730 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5731 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5732 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5733 front of an existing proxy.
5734
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005735 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5736
5737 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5738 http-server-close".
5739
5740
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005741option httpchk
5742option httpchk <uri>
5743option httpchk <method> <uri>
5744option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5745 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | no | yes | yes
5748 Arguments :
5749 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5750 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5751 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5752 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5753 ones.
5754
5755 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5756 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5757 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5758
5759 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5760 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5761 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5762 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5763 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5764
5765 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5766 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5767 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5768 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5769 the lack of any response.
5770
5771 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5772
5773 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5774 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5775 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5776
5777 Examples :
5778 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5779 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5780 backend https_relay
5781 mode tcp
5782 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5783 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5784
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005785 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5786 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5787 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005788
5789
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005790option httpclose
5791no option httpclose
5792 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 yes | yes | yes | yes
5795 Arguments : none
5796
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005797 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5798 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5799 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5800 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005801 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005802 "option http-tunnel".
5803
5804 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5805 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5806 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5807 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5808 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5809 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5810 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5811 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005812
5813 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005814 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005815 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5816 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5817 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5818 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5819 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005820
5821 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5822 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005823 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5824 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005825 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5826 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005827
5828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5830
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005831 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5832 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005833
5834
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005835option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005836 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5838 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005839 Arguments :
5840 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5841 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5842 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5843 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5844 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005845
5846 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5847 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5848 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5849 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5850 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5851 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5852 ports.
5853
5854 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5855
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005856 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5857 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005858
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005859 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005861 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005862
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005863
5864option http_proxy
5865no option http_proxy
5866 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 yes | yes | yes | yes
5869 Arguments : none
5870
5871 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5872 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5873 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5874 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5875 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5876
5877 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5878 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005879 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5880 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005881
5882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5884
5885 Example :
5886 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5887 backend direct_forward
5888 option httpclose
5889 option http_proxy
5890
5891 See also : "option httpclose"
5892
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005893
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005894option independent-streams
5895no option independent-streams
5896 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5898 yes | yes | yes | yes
5899 Arguments : none
5900
5901 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5902 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5903 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5904 receive data or not.
5905
5906 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5907 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5908 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5909 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5910 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5911 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5912 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5913 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5914 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5915 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5916 socket buffers.
5917
5918 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5919 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5920 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5921 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5922 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5923
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005924 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005925 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5926 deprecated.
5927
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005928 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005929
5930
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005931option ldap-check
5932 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | no | yes | yes
5935 Arguments : none
5936
5937 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5938 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5939 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5940 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5941
5942 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5943 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5944
5945 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5946 configure it.
5947
5948 Example :
5949 option ldap-check
5950
5951 See also : "option httpchk"
5952
5953
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005954option external-check
5955 Use external processes for server health checks
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | no | yes | yes
5958
5959 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5960 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5961 command".
5962
5963 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5964
5965 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5966
5967
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005968option log-health-checks
5969no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005970 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 yes | no | yes | yes
5973 Arguments : none
5974
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005975 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5976 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5977 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005978
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005979 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5980 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5981 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5982 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5983 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5984
5985 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5986 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005987
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005988 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5989 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5990 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005991
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005992
5993option log-separate-errors
5994no option log-separate-errors
5995 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | yes | yes | no
5998 Arguments : none
5999
6000 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6001 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6002 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6003 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6004 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6005 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6006 provides very important information.
6007
6008 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6009 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6010 error logs.
6011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006012 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006013 logging.
6014
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006015
6016option logasap
6017no option logasap
6018 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 yes | yes | yes | no
6021 Arguments : none
6022
6023 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6024 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6025 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6026 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6027 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6028 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6029 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006030 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006031 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6032 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6033
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006034 Examples :
6035 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6036 mode http
6037 option httplog
6038 option logasap
6039 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6040
6041 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6042 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6043 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6044 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006046 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006047 logging.
6048
6049
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006050option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006051 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6053 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006054 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006055 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6056 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006057 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006058
6059 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6060 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6061 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6062 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6063 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6064 in the MySQL table, like this :
6065
6066 USE mysql;
6067 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6068 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6069
6070 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6071 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6072 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6073 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6074 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6075 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6076 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6077 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6078 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6079
6080 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6081 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006082
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006083 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006084
6085 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6086 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6087 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6088 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006089 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6090 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006091
6092 See also: "option httpchk"
6093
6094
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006095option nolinger
6096no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006097 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006100 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006101
6102 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6103 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6104 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6105 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6106 connections.
6107
6108 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6109 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6110 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6111 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6112 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6113 this too.
6114
6115 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6116 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6117 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6118
6119 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6120 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6121 for servers.
6122
6123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6125
6126
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006127option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6128 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | yes | yes | yes
6131 Arguments :
6132 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6133 matching <network>
6134 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6135 header name.
6136
6137 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6138 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6139 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6140 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6141 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6142 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6143 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6144 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6145 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6146 possible that the client has already brought one.
6147
6148 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6149 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6150 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6151 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6152 header and requires different one.
6153
6154 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6155 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6156 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6157 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6158 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6159 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6160 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6161
6162 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6163 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6164 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6165 both are defined.
6166
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006167 Examples :
6168 # Original Destination address
6169 frontend www
6170 mode http
6171 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6172
6173 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6174 backend www
6175 mode http
6176 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6177
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006178 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6179 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006180
6181
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006182option persist
6183no option persist
6184 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006187 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006188
6189 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6190 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6191 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6192 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6193 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6194 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6195 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6196 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6197 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6198 redirected to another valid server.
6199
6200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6202
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006203 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006204
6205
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006206option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6207 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | no | yes | yes
6210 Arguments :
6211 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6212 PostgreSQL server.
6213
6214 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6215 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6216 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6217 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6218
6219 See also: "option httpchk"
6220
6221
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006222option prefer-last-server
6223no option prefer-last-server
6224 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | no | yes | yes
6227 Arguments : none
6228
6229 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6230 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6231 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6232 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6233 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6234 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6235 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6236 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6237 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006238 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6239 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6240 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6241 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6242 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6243 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6244 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006245
6246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6248
6249 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6250
6251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006252option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006253option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006254no option redispatch
6255 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6257 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006258 Arguments :
6259 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6260 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6261 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6262 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6263 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6264 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6265 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6266 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6267 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006269
6270 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6271 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6272 be able to access the service anymore.
6273
6274 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6275 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6276
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006277 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006278 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6279 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006281 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6282 "redisp" keywords.
6283
6284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6286
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006287 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006288
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006289
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006290option redis-check
6291 Use redis health checks for server testing
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | no | yes | yes
6294 Arguments : none
6295
6296 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6297 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6298 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6299 find the "+PONG" response message.
6300
6301 Example :
6302 option redis-check
6303
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006304 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006305
6306
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006307option smtpchk
6308option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6309 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006312 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006313 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6314 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6315 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6316
6317 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6318 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6319 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6320
6321 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6322 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6323 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6324 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6325 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6326 dead server.
6327
6328 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6329 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6330 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6331 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6332
6333 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6334 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6335 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6336 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006337 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006338
6339 Example :
6340 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6341
6342 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006345option socket-stats
6346no option socket-stats
6347
6348 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6350 yes | yes | yes | no
6351
6352 Arguments : none
6353
6354
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006355option splice-auto
6356no option splice-auto
6357 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6359 yes | yes | yes | yes
6360 Arguments : none
6361
6362 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6363 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6364 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6365 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006366 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006367 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6368 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6369 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6370 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6371
6372 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6373 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6374 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6375 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6376 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6377 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6378 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6379 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6380 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6381 keyword.
6382
6383 Example :
6384 option splice-auto
6385
6386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6388
6389 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6390 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6391
6392
6393option splice-request
6394no option splice-request
6395 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | yes | yes | yes
6398 Arguments : none
6399
6400 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006401 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006402 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6403 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6404 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6405 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6406
6407 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6408
6409 Example :
6410 option splice-request
6411
6412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6414
6415 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6416 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6417
6418
6419option splice-response
6420no option splice-response
6421 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 yes | yes | yes | yes
6424 Arguments : none
6425
6426 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006427 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006428 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6429 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6430 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6431 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6432
6433 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6434
6435 Example :
6436 option splice-response
6437
6438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6440
6441 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6442 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6443
6444
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006445option spop-check
6446 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6448 no | no | no | yes
6449 Arguments : none
6450
6451 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6452 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6453 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6454 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6455
6456 Example :
6457 option spop-check
6458
6459 See also : "option httpchk"
6460
6461
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006462option srvtcpka
6463no option srvtcpka
6464 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | no | yes | yes
6467 Arguments : none
6468
6469 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6470 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6471 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6472 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6473
6474 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6475 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6476 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6477 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6478
6479 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6480 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6481 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6482 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6483 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6484
6485 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6486
6487 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6488 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6489 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6490
6491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6493
6494 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6495
6496
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006497option ssl-hello-chk
6498 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6500 yes | no | yes | yes
6501 Arguments : none
6502
6503 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6504 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6505 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6506 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6507 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6508 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6509 hello message.
6510
6511 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6512 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6513 messages, which is appreciable.
6514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006515 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6516 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6517 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006518
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006519 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6520
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006521
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006522option tcp-check
6523 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | no | yes | yes
6526
6527 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6528 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6529
6530 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6531 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6532 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006534 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006535 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6536 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6537 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6538 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6539 only.
6540
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006541 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006542 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6543 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6544 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6545 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6546
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006547 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006548 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6549 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006550 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006551 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6552 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6553 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6554 the respective protocols.
6555 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6556 analysed.
6557
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006558 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6559 script.
6560
6561 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6562 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6563 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6564 The "comment" is of course optional.
6565
6566
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006567 Examples :
6568 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6569 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006570 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006571
6572 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6573 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006574 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006575
6576 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6577 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006578 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006579 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006580 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006581 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006582 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006583 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006584 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6585 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006586 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006587 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6588 tcp-check expect string +OK
6589
6590 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6591 (send many headers before analyzing)
6592 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006593 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006594 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6595 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6596 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6597 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006598 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006599
6600
6601 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6602
6603
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006604option tcp-smart-accept
6605no option tcp-smart-accept
6606 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | yes | yes | no
6609 Arguments : none
6610
6611 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6612 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6613 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6614 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6615 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6616 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6617
6618 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6619 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6620 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6621 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6622
6623 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6624 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6625 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6626 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6627
6628 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6629 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6630 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6631
6632 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6633 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6634 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6635
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006636 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6637
6638
6639option tcp-smart-connect
6640no option tcp-smart-connect
6641 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6643 yes | no | yes | yes
6644 Arguments : none
6645
6646 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6647 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6648 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6649 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6650 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6651
6652 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6653 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6654 complex.
6655
6656 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6657 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6658 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6659
6660 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6661 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6662
6663 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6664
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006665
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006666option tcpka
6667 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 yes | yes | yes | yes
6670 Arguments : none
6671
6672 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6673 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6674 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6675 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6676
6677 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6678 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6679 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6680 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6681
6682 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6683 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6684 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6685 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6686 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6687
6688 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6689
6690 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6691 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6692 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6693 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6694 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6695 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6696 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6697 backends.
6698
6699 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6700
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006701
6702option tcplog
6703 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 yes | yes | yes | yes
6706 Arguments : none
6707
6708 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6709 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6710 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6711 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6712 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6713 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6714 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6715 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6716
6717 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6718
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006719 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006721 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006722
6723
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006724option transparent
6725no option transparent
6726 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006728 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006729 Arguments : none
6730
6731 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6732 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6733 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6734 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6735 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6736 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6737 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6738 appropriate server.
6739
6740 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6741 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6742
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006743 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006744 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006745
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006746
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006747external-check command <command>
6748 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6750 yes | no | yes | yes
6751
6752 Arguments :
6753 <command> is the external command to run
6754
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006755 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6756
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006757 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006758
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006759 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6760 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6761 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6762 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6763 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6764 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006765
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006766 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6767
6768 Environment variables :
6769 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6770 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6771
6772 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6773
6774 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6775
6776 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6777 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6778 for a UNIX socket).
6779
6780 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6781
6782 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6783
6784 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6785
6786 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6787
6788 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6789
6790 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6791 socket).
6792
6793 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6794 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6795
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006796 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6797 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6798 failed.
6799
6800 Example :
6801 external-check command /bin/true
6802
6803 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6804
6805
6806external-check path <path>
6807 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | no | yes | yes
6810
6811 Arguments :
6812 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6813
6814 The default path is "".
6815
6816 Example :
6817 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6818
6819 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6820 "external-check command"
6821
6822
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006823persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006824persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006825 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | no | yes | yes
6828 Arguments :
6829 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006830 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6831 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006832
6833 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6834 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6835 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6836 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6837 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6838 forwarded to this server.
6839
6840 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6841 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6842 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006843 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006844 a single "listen" section.
6845
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006846 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6847 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6848 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6849
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006850 Example :
6851 listen tse-farm
6852 bind :3389
6853 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6854 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6855 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6856 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6857 persist rdp-cookie
6858 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006859 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006860 balance rdp-cookie
6861 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6862 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6863
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006864 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6865 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006866
6867
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006868rate-limit sessions <rate>
6869 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6871 yes | yes | yes | no
6872 Arguments :
6873 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6874 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6875
6876 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6877 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6878 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6879 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6880 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6881 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6882
6883 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6884 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6885 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6886 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6887
6888 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6889 listen smtp
6890 mode tcp
6891 bind :25
6892 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006893 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006894
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006895 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6896 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6897 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006898
6899 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6900
6901
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006902redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6903redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6904redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006905 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6907 no | yes | yes | yes
6908
6909 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006910 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006911
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006913 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006914 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6915 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6916 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006917
6918 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6919 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6920 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6921 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6922 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006923 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6924 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6925 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6926 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006927
6928 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6929 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6930 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6931 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6932 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6933 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006934 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006935 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006936 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6937 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6938 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006939
6940 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006941 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6942 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6943 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006944 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006945 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6946 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6947 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6948 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006949
6950 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6951 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6952
6953 - "drop-query"
6954 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6955 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6956 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6957 with a location-type redirect.
6958
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006959 - "append-slash"
6960 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6961 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6962 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6963 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6964
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006965 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6966 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6967 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6968 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6969 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6970 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6971 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6972
6973 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6974 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6975 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6976 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6977 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6978 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6979 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006980
6981 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6982 acl clear dst_port 80
6983 acl secure dst_port 8080
6984 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006985 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006986 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006987 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6988
6989 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006990 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6991 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6992 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006993 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006994
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006995 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6996 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6997 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6998
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006999 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007000 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007001
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007002 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007003 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7004 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7005 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007007 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007008
7009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007010redisp (deprecated)
7011redispatch (deprecated)
7012 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7014 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007015 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007016
7017 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7018 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7019 be able to access the service anymore.
7020
7021 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7022 redistribute them to a working server.
7023
7024 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7025 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7026 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007028 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7029 "option redispatch" instead.
7030
7031 See also : "option redispatch"
7032
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007033
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007034reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007035 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 no | yes | yes | yes
7038 Arguments :
7039 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7040 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007041 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007042
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007043 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7044 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7045
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007046 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7047 the last header of an HTTP request.
7048
7049 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7050 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7051 responses.
7052
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007053 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7054 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7055 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7056
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007057 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7058 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007059
7060
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007061reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7062reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007063 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7065 no | yes | yes | yes
7066 Arguments :
7067 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7068 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7069 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7070 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7071 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7072 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7073 ignores case.
7074
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007075 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7076 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7077
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007078 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7079 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7080 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7081 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007082 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007083
7084 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7085 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7086
7087 Example :
7088 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7089 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7090 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7091
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007092 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7093 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094
7095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007096reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7097reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007098 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7100 no | yes | yes | yes
7101 Arguments :
7102 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7103 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7104 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7105 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7106 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7107 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7108
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007109 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7110 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7111
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007112 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7113 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7114 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7115 next servers.
7116
7117 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7118 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7119 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7120
7121 Example :
7122 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7123 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7124 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7125
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007126 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7127 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007128
7129
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007130reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7131reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007132 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7134 no | yes | yes | yes
7135 Arguments :
7136 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7137 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7138 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7139 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7140 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7141 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7142 case.
7143
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007144 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7145 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7146
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7148 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7149 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7150 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007151 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007152
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007153 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007154 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007155 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007156
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007157 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7158 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7159
7160 Example :
7161 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7162 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7163 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7164
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007165 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7166 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007167
7168
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007169reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7170reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007171 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 no | yes | yes | yes
7174 Arguments :
7175 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7176 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7177 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7178 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7179 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7180 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7181 case.
7182
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007183 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7184 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7185
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007186 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7187 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7188 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7189 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7190
7191 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7192 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7193
7194 Example :
7195 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7196 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7197 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7198 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7199
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007200 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7201 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007202
7203
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007204reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7205reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007206 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7208 no | yes | yes | yes
7209 Arguments :
7210 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7211 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7212 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7213 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7214 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7215 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7216
7217 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7218 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7219 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7220 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007221 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007222
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007223 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7224 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7225
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7227 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7228 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7229
7230 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7231 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7232 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7233 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7234 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7235
7236 Example :
7237 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007238 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007239 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7240 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7241
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007242 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7243 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007244
7245
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007246reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7247reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007248 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7250 no | yes | yes | yes
7251 Arguments :
7252 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7253 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7254 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7255 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7256 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7257 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7258 ignores case.
7259
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007260 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7261 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7262
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007263 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7264 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007265 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7266 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7267 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007268 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7269 not set.
7270
7271 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7272 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7273 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7274 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7275 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7276
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007277 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007278 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7279 # block all others.
7280 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7281 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7282
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007283 # block bad guys
7284 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7285 reqitarpit . if badguys
7286
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007287 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7288 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007289
7290
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007291retries <value>
7292 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | no | yes | yes
7295 Arguments :
7296 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7297 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7298 default value is 3.
7299
7300 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7301 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7302 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7303
7304 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007305 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7306 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007307
7308 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7309 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7310
7311 See also : "option redispatch"
7312
7313
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007314rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007315 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 no | yes | yes | yes
7318 Arguments :
7319 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7320 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007321 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007322
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007323 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7324 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7325
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007326 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7327 the last header of an HTTP response.
7328
7329 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7330 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7331 responses.
7332
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007333 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7334 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007335
7336
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007337rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7338rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007339 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7341 no | yes | yes | yes
7342 Arguments :
7343 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7344 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7345 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7346 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7347 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7348 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7349 ignores case.
7350
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007351 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7352 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7353
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007354 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7355 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007356 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007357 client.
7358
7359 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7360 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7361 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7362
7363 Example :
7364 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007365 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007366
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007367 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7368 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369
7370
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007371rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7372rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007373 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 no | yes | yes | yes
7376 Arguments :
7377 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7378 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7379 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7380 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7381 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7382 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7383 ignores case.
7384
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007385 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7386 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7387
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007388 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7389 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7390 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7391 case-sensitive.
7392
7393 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007394 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7395 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7396 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007397
7398 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7399 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7400
7401 Example :
7402 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7403 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7404
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007405 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7406 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007407
7408
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007409rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7410rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007411 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 no | yes | yes | yes
7414 Arguments :
7415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7416 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7417 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7418 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7419 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7420 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7421 ignores case.
7422
7423 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7424 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7425 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7426 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007427 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007428
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007429 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7430 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7431
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007432 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7433 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7434 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7435
7436 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7437 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7438 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7439 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7440 are not case-sensitive.
7441
7442 Example :
7443 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7444 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7445
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007446 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7447 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007448
7449
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007450server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007451 Declare a server in a backend
7452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7453 no | no | yes | yes
7454 Arguments :
7455 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007456 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007457 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007458
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007459 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7460 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7461 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7462 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007463 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7464 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7465 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7466 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7467 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007468 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7469 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7470 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7471 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7472 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7473 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7474 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007475 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007476 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7477 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007478 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7479 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007481 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007482 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7483 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7484 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7485 adding this value to the client's port.
7486
7487 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7488 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007489 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007490
7491 Examples :
7492 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7493 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007494 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007495 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7496 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7497 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007498
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007499 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7500 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7501 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7502 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7503 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7504
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007505 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7506 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007507
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007508server-state-file-name [<file>]
7509 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7510 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7511 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7512 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7513 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7514 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7515
7516 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7517 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7518
7519 global
7520 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7521
7522 backend bk
7523 load-server-state-from-file
7524
7525 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7526 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007527
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007528server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7529 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7530 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7532 no | no | yes | yes
7533
7534 Arguments:
7535 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7536
7537 <num | range>
7538 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7539 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7540 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7541 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7542
7543 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7544
7545 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7546
7547 <params*>
7548 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7549 keyword.
7550
7551 Examples:
7552 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7553 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7554 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7555
7556 # or
7557 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7558
7559 # would be equivalent to:
7560 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7561 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7562 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7563
7564
7565
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007566source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007567source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007568source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007569 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | no | yes | yes
7572 Arguments :
7573 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7574 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007575
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007576 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007577 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7578 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7579 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7580 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7581 supported prefixes are :
7582 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7583 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7584 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007585 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007586 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7587 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007588
7589 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7590 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007591 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7592 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7593 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007594
7595 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7596 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7597 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7598 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7599 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7600 <addr>.
7601
7602 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7603 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7604 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7605 port.
7606
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007607 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7608 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7609 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7610 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007611 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007612 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7613 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7614 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7615 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7616 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7617 HTTP header.
7618
7619 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7620 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007621 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007622 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7623 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7624 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7625 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7626 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7627 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7628 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7629
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007630 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7631 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7632 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7633 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7634 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7635 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7636
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007637 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7638 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7639 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7640 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7641
7642 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7643 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7644 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7645 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7646 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7647 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7648
7649 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7650 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7651 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7652 there are two methods :
7653
7654 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7655 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7656 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7657 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7658 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7659 of the client ranges may be used.
7660
7661 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7662 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7663 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7664 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7665 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7666 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7667 same session.
7668
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007669 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7670 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7671 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007672 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007673
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007674 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7675
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007676 Examples :
7677 backend private
7678 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7679 source 192.168.1.200
7680
7681 backend transparent_ssl1
7682 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7683 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7684
7685 backend transparent_ssl2
7686 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7687 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7688 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7689
7690 backend transparent_ssl3
7691 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7692 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7693 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7694
7695 backend transparent_smtp
7696 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7697 # with Tproxy version 4.
7698 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7699
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007700 backend transparent_http
7701 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7702 # proxy.
7703 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007705 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007706 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007708
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007709srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7710 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | no | yes | yes
7713 Arguments :
7714 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7716 as explained at the top of this document.
7717
7718 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7719 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7720 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7721 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7722 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7723 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7724 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7725
7726 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7727 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7728 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7729 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7730 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007731 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007732 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007733 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007734
7735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7739 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7741
7742 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7743 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7744
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007745 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7746 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007747
7748
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007749stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7750 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007752 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007753
7754 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7755 matched.
7756
7757 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7758 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007760 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7761 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7762 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7763
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007764 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7765 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7766 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7767 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007768
7769 Example :
7770 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7771 backend stats_localhost
7772 stats enable
7773 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7774
7775 Example :
7776 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7777 backend stats_auth
7778 stats enable
7779 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7780 stats admin if TRUE
7781
7782 Example :
7783 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7784 userlist stats-auth
7785 group admin users admin
7786 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7787 group readonly users haproxy
7788 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7789
7790 backend stats_auth
7791 stats enable
7792 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7793 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7794 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7795 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7796
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007797 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7798 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7799 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007800
7801
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007802stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7803 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007806 Arguments :
7807 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7808
7809 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7810
7811 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7812 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7813 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7814 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7815 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7816 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7817
7818 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7819 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7820 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007821 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007822
7823 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7824 report using "stats scope".
7825
7826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7828 unobvious parameters.
7829
7830 Example :
7831 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7832 backend public_www
7833 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7834 stats enable
7835 stats hide-version
7836 stats scope .
7837 stats uri /admin?stats
7838 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7839 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7840 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7841
7842 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7843 backend private_monitoring
7844 stats enable
7845 stats uri /admin?stats
7846 stats refresh 5s
7847
7848 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7849
7850
7851stats enable
7852 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007855 Arguments : none
7856
7857 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7858 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7859 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7860 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7861 - stats auth : no authentication
7862 - stats scope : no restriction
7863
7864 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7865 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7866 unobvious parameters.
7867
7868 Example :
7869 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7870 backend public_www
7871 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7872 stats enable
7873 stats hide-version
7874 stats scope .
7875 stats uri /admin?stats
7876 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7877 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7878 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7879
7880 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7881 backend private_monitoring
7882 stats enable
7883 stats uri /admin?stats
7884 stats refresh 5s
7885
7886 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7887
7888
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007889stats hide-version
7890 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007892 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007893 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007895 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7896 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7897 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7898 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7899 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7900 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7904 unobvious parameters.
7905
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007906 Example :
7907 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7908 backend public_www
7909 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007910 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007911 stats hide-version
7912 stats scope .
7913 stats uri /admin?stats
7914 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7915 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7916 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007917
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007918 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7919 backend private_monitoring
7920 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007921 stats uri /admin?stats
7922 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007924 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007925
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007926
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007927stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7929 Access control for statistics
7930
7931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 no | no | yes | yes
7933
7934 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7935 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7936 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7937 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7938 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7939 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7940
7941 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7942 instance.
7943
7944 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7945 about ACL usage.
7946
7947
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007948stats realm <realm>
7949 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007951 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007952 Arguments :
7953 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7954 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7955 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7956
7957 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7958 using a backslash ('\').
7959
7960 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7961 only related to authentication.
7962
7963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7965 unobvious parameters.
7966
7967 Example :
7968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7969 backend public_www
7970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7971 stats enable
7972 stats hide-version
7973 stats scope .
7974 stats uri /admin?stats
7975 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7978
7979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7980 backend private_monitoring
7981 stats enable
7982 stats uri /admin?stats
7983 stats refresh 5s
7984
7985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7986
7987
7988stats refresh <delay>
7989 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992 Arguments :
7993 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7994 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7995 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7996 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7997 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7998 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7999
8000 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8001 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8002 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8003 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8004
8005 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8006 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8007 unobvious parameters.
8008
8009 Example :
8010 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8011 backend public_www
8012 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8013 stats enable
8014 stats hide-version
8015 stats scope .
8016 stats uri /admin?stats
8017 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8018 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8019 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8020
8021 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8022 backend private_monitoring
8023 stats enable
8024 stats uri /admin?stats
8025 stats refresh 5s
8026
8027 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8028
8029
8030stats scope { <name> | "." }
8031 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008033 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008034 Arguments :
8035 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8036 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8037 section in which the statement appears.
8038
8039 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8040 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8041 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8042 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8043 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8044 exists.
8045
8046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8048 unobvious parameters.
8049
8050 Example :
8051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8052 backend public_www
8053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8054 stats enable
8055 stats hide-version
8056 stats scope .
8057 stats uri /admin?stats
8058 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8061
8062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8063 backend private_monitoring
8064 stats enable
8065 stats uri /admin?stats
8066 stats refresh 5s
8067
8068 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008070
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008071stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008076 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008077 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8078
8079 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8080 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8081
8082 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8083 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008084 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008085
8086 Example :
8087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8088 backend private_monitoring
8089 stats enable
8090 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8091 stats uri /admin?stats
8092 stats refresh 5s
8093
8094 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8095 global section.
8096
8097
8098stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008099 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8101 yes | yes | yes | yes
8102 Arguments : none
8103
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008104 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008105 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8106 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8107 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8108 - IP (socket, server)
8109 - cookie (backend, server)
8110
8111 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8112 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008113 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008114
8115 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8116
8117
8118stats show-node [ <name> ]
8119 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008122 Arguments:
8123 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8124 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8125
8126 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8127 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008128 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008129
8130 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8131 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8132 unobvious parameters.
8133
8134 Example:
8135 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8136 backend private_monitoring
8137 stats enable
8138 stats show-node Europe-1
8139 stats uri /admin?stats
8140 stats refresh 5s
8141
8142 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8143 section.
8144
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145
8146stats uri <prefix>
8147 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008149 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008150 Arguments :
8151 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8152 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8153 query string.
8154
8155 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8156 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8157 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8158 possible to reach it in the application.
8159
8160 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008161 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8163 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8164 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8165 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8166
8167 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8168 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8169 an address or a port to statistics only.
8170
8171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8173 unobvious parameters.
8174
8175 Example :
8176 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8177 backend public_www
8178 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8179 stats enable
8180 stats hide-version
8181 stats scope .
8182 stats uri /admin?stats
8183 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8184 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8185 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8186
8187 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8188 backend private_monitoring
8189 stats enable
8190 stats uri /admin?stats
8191 stats refresh 5s
8192
8193 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8194
8195
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008196stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8197 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008199 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008200
8201 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008202 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008203 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8204 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8205 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8206
8207 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8208 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8209 the "stick-table" statement.
8210
8211 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8212 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8213 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8214 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8215 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8216
8217 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8218 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8219 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8220 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8221 transformation rules.
8222
8223 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8224 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8225 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8226 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8227 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8228 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8229 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8230
8231 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8232 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8233 ACL based conditions.
8234
8235 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8236 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8237 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8238 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8239
8240 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8241 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8242 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8243 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8244
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008245 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8246 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8247 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8248
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008249 Example :
8250 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8251 # last 30 minutes
8252 backend pop
8253 mode tcp
8254 balance roundrobin
8255 stick store-request src
8256 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8257 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8258 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8259
8260 backend smtp
8261 mode tcp
8262 balance roundrobin
8263 stick match src table pop
8264 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8265 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8266
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008267 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008268 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008269
8270
8271stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8272 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8274 no | no | yes | yes
8275
8276 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8277 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8278 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8279 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8280
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008281 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8282 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8283 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8284
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008285 Examples :
8286 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008287 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008288
8289 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8290 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8291 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8292
8293
8294 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8295 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8296 backend http
8297 mode http
8298 balance roundrobin
8299 stick on src table https
8300 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8301 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8302 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8303
8304 backend https
8305 mode tcp
8306 balance roundrobin
8307 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8308 stick on src
8309 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8310 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8311
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008312 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008313
8314
8315stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8316 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8318 no | no | yes | yes
8319
8320 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008321 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008322 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8323 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8324 server is selected.
8325
8326 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8327 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8328 the "stick-table" statement.
8329
8330 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8331 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8332 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8333 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8334 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8335 address.
8336
8337 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8338 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8339 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8340 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8341 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8342 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8343 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8344 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8345 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8346 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8347
8348 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8349 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8350 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8351 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8352 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8353 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8354 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8355
8356 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8357 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8358 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8359 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8360
8361 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8362 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8363 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8364 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8365 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8366 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008367 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8368 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8369 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8370 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8371 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8372 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008373
8374 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8375 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8376 the request.
8377
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008378 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8379 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8380 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8381
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008382 Example :
8383 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8384 # last 30 minutes
8385 backend pop
8386 mode tcp
8387 balance roundrobin
8388 stick store-request src
8389 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8390 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8391 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8392
8393 backend smtp
8394 mode tcp
8395 balance roundrobin
8396 stick match src table pop
8397 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8398 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8399
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008400 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008401 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008402
8403
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008404stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008405 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8406 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008407 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008409 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008410
8411 Arguments :
8412 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8413 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8414 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8415 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8416
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008417 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8418 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8419 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8420 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8421
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008422 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8423 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8424 instance.
8425
8426 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8427 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8428 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8429 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8430 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8431 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008432 to 32 characters.
8433
8434 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8435 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8436 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008437 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008438 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8439 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008440
8441 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008442 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8443 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008444 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8445 increase.
8446
8447 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008448 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8449 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8450 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008451
8452 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8453 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8454 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8455 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8456 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8457 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8458 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8459 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8460 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8461 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8462 parameter (see below).
8463
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008464 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8465 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8466 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8467 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8468 soft restart.
8469
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008470 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8471 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008472
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008473 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8474 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8475 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8476 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8477 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008478 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008479 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8480 if not expiration delay is specified.
8481
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008482 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8483 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8484 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8485 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008486 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8487 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8488 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8489 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8490 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8491 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8492 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8493 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8494 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8495 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8496 types and their arguments.
8497
8498 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8499 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8500 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8501 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8502
8503 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8504 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8505 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8506 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8507
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008508 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8509 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8510 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8511 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8512 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8513 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8514
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008515 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8516 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8517 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8518 they were received.
8519
8520 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8521 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8522 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8523 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8524 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8525
8526 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8527 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8528 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8529 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8530 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8531
8532 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8533 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8534 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8535
8536 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8537 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8538 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8539 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8540 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8541
8542 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8543 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8544 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8545 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8546 the client side.
8547
8548 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8549 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8550 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8551 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8552 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8553 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8554 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8555
8556 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8557 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8558 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8559 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8560 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8561 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8562 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8563
8564 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8565 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8566 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8567 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8568 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8569 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8570
8571 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8572 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8573 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8574 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8575
8576 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8577 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8578 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8579 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8580 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8581 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8582 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8583 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8584 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8585 recommended for better fairness.
8586
8587 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8588 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8589 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8590 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8591
8592 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8593 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8595 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8596 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8597 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8598 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8599 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8600 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8601 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008602
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008603 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8604 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008605 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8606 reference it.
8607
8608 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8609 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008610 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8611 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8612 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008613
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008614 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8615 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8616 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8617 something that can be ignored.
8618
8619 Example:
8620 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8621 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8622 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8623 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8624
8625 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008626 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008627
8628
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008629stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008630 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8632 no | no | yes | yes
8633
8634 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008635 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008636 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8637 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8638 server is selected.
8639
8640 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8641 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8642 the "stick-table" statement.
8643
8644 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8645 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8646 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8647 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8648
8649 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8650 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8651 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8652 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8653 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8654 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008655 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008656 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8657 rules.
8658
8659 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8660 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8661 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8662 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8663 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8664 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8665 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8666
8667 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8668 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8669 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8670 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8671
8672 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8673 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8674 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8675 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8676 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8677 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008678 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8679 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8680 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8681 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8682 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8683 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8684 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8685 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8686 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008687
8688 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8689
8690 Example :
8691 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8692 backend https
8693 mode tcp
8694 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008695 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008696 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008697
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008698 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8699 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8700
8701 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8702 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8703 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8704
8705 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8706 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008707
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008708 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8709 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8710 # at offset 44.
8711
8712 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8713 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8714
8715 # Learn on response if server hello.
8716 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008717
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008718 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8719 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8720
8721 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8722 extraction.
8723
8724
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008725tcp-check connect [params*]
8726 Opens a new connection
8727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8728 no | no | yes | yes
8729
8730 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8731 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8732 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8733
8734 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8735 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8736 of the sequence.
8737
8738 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8739 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8740 do.
8741
8742 Parameters :
8743 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8744 use the TCP connection.
8745
8746 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8747 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8748 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8749
8750 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8751
8752 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8753
8754 Examples:
8755 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8756 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8757 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8758 option tcp-check
8759 tcp-check connect
8760 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8761 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8762 tcp-check send \r\n
8763 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8764 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8765 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8766 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8767 tcp-check send \r\n
8768 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8769 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8770
8771 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8772 option tcp-check
8773 tcp-check connect port 110
8774 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8775 tcp-check connect port 143
8776 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8777 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8778
8779 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8780
8781
8782tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8783 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8785 no | no | yes | yes
8786
8787 Arguments :
8788 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8789 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8790 binary.
8791 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8792 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8793 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8794
8795 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8796 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8797 with the usual backslash ('\').
8798 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8799 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8800 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8801 used upper or lower case.
8802
8803
8804 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8805
8806 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8807 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8808 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8809 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8810 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8811 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8812 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8813 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8814
8815 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8816 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8817 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8818 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8819 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8820 expression.
8821
8822 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8823 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8824 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8825 this exact hexadecimal string.
8826 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8827
8828 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8829 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8830 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8831 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8832 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8833 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8834 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8835 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8836 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8837 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8838 the null character.
8839
8840 Examples :
8841 # perform a POP check
8842 option tcp-check
8843 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8844
8845 # perform an IMAP check
8846 option tcp-check
8847 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8848
8849 # look for the redis master server
8850 option tcp-check
8851 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008852 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008853 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8854 tcp-check expect string role:master
8855 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8856 tcp-check expect string +OK
8857
8858
8859 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8860 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8861
8862
8863tcp-check send <data>
8864 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 no | no | yes | yes
8867
8868 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8869 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8870
8871 Examples :
8872 # look for the redis master server
8873 option tcp-check
8874 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8875 tcp-check expect string role:master
8876
8877 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8878 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8879
8880
8881tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8882 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8883 tcp health check
8884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8885 no | no | yes | yes
8886
8887 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8888 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8889 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8890 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8891 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8892 hexadecimal string.
8893 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8894
8895 Examples :
8896 # redis check in binary
8897 option tcp-check
8898 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8899 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8900
8901
8902 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8903 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8904
8905
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008906tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8907 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8909 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008911 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8912 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008913
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008914 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008915
8916 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8917 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008918 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8919 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8920 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8921 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8922 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8923 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008925 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8926 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8927 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8928 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008929
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008930 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008931 - accept :
8932 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8933 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8934 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008936 - reject :
8937 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8938 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8939 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8940 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8941 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8942 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8943 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8944 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8945 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8946 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8947 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008948 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008949
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008950 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8951 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8952 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8953 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8954 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8955 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8956 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8957 hosts.
8958
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008959 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8960 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8961 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8962 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8963 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8964 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8965 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8966 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8967
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008968 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8969 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8970 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8971 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8972 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8973 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8974 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8975 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8976 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008977 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8978 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008979
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008980 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008981 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008982 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008983 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008984 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8985 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008986 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008987 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8988 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8989 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8990 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8991 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008993 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008994 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008995 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008996 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8997 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8998 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8999 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009001 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9002 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9003 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9004 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009006 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9007 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9008 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9009 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9010 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009011 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9012 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9013 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9014 layer7 information is extracted.
9015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009016 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9017 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9018 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9019 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9020 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009021
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009022 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9023 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9024 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9025 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9026
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009027 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9028 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9029 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9030 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9031 continues.
9032
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009033 - set-src <expr> :
9034 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9035 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9036 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9037 set-src"
9038
9039 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9040 followed by some converters.
9041
9042 Example:
9043
9044 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9045
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009046 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9047 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009048
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009049 - set-src-port <expr> :
9050 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9051 expression.
9052
9053 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9054 followed by some converters.
9055
9056 Example:
9057
9058 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9059
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009060 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9061 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9062 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009063
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009064 - set-dst <expr> :
9065 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9066 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9067 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9068 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9069 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9070
9071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9072 followed by some converters.
9073
9074 Example:
9075
9076 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9077 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9078
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009079 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9080 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9081
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009082 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9083 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9084 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9085 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9086
9087
9088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9089 followed by some converters.
9090
9091 Example:
9092
9093 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9094
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009095 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9096 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9097 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9098
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009099 - "silent-drop" :
9100 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9101 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9102 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9103 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9104 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9105 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9106 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9107 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9108 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9109 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9110 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9111 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9112 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9113 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9114 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9115 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009117 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9118 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9119 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009121 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9122 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9123 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009126 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009127 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009129 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9130 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9131 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009134 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9135 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009136
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009137 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9138
9139 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9140
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9142
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009143 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009144
9145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009146tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9147 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009149 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009150 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009151 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9152 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009154 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009156 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9157 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9158 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9159 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9160 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009162 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9163 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9164 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9165 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009166 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9167 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9168 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9169 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9170 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9171 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009172 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009173 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009175 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9176 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9177 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9178 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009179
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009180 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009181 - accept : the request is accepted
9182 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9183 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009184 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009185 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009186 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009187 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009188 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009189 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9192 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009193
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009194 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9195 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9196 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9197 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9198 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9199 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009201 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009202 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9203 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009206 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9207 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9208 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9209 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009210 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9211 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9212 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009213
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009214 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009215 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9216 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9217 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009218
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009219 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009220 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9221 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009222
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009223 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9224 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009228 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009230 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009231 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9232 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009233 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009234 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9235 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009236
9237 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9238 followed by some converters.
9239
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009240 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9241 <var-name>.
9242
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009243 Example:
9244
9245 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009246 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009247
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009248 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009249 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9250 # and reject everything else.
9251 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9252 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009253 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009254 tcp-request content reject
9255
9256 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009257 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9258 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9259 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009260 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009261
9262 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9263 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9264 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009265 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009266 tcp-request content reject
9267
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009268 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009269 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009270 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009271 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009272 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9273 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009274
9275 Example:
9276 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9277 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009278 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009280 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009281 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009282
9283 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009284 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009285 # protecting all our sites
9286 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009287 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9288 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009289 ...
9290 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9291
9292 backend http_dynamic
9293 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009294 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009295 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009296 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009297 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009298 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009299 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009301 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009303 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9304 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009305
9306
9307tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9308 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009310 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009311 Arguments :
9312 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9314 as explained at the top of this document.
9315
9316 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9317 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9318 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9319 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9320 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9321
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009322 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9323 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9324 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9325 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9326
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009327 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9328 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009329 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009330 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009331 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9332 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9333 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9334 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009335
9336 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9337 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9338 it pass through unaffected.
9339
9340 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9341 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9342 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009343 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009344 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9345 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009346 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9347 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9348 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009350 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009351 "timeout client".
9352
9353
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009354tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9355 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9357 no | no | yes | yes
9358 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009359 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9360 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009361
9362 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9363
9364 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9365 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9366 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009367 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9368 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009369
9370 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9371
9372 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9373 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9374 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9375 inserted.
9376
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009377 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009378 - accept :
9379 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9380 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9381 the rules evaluation.
9382
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009383 - close :
9384 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9385 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9386 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9387 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9388 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9389 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009390 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009391 protocols.
9392
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009393 - reject :
9394 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9395 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009396 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009397
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009398 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9399 Sets a variable.
9400
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009401 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9402 Unsets a variable.
9403
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009404 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9405 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9406 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9407 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9408
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009409 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9410 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9411 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9412 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9413 continues.
9414
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009415 - "silent-drop" :
9416 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9417 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9418 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9419 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9420 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9421 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9422 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9423 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9424 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9425 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9426 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9427 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9428 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9429 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9430 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9431 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9432
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009433 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9434 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9435 for changing the default action to a reject.
9436
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009437 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9438 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9439 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9440 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009441 period.
9442
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009443 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9444 declared inline.
9445
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009446 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9447 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009448 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009449 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9450 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009451 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009452 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009453 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009454 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9455 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009456 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009457 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9458 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009459
9460 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9461 followed by some converters.
9462
9463 Example:
9464
9465 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9466
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009467 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9468 <var-name>.
9469
9470 Example:
9471
9472 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9473
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009474 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9475
9476 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9477
9478
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009479tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9480 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9482 no | yes | yes | no
9483 Arguments :
9484 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9485 below.
9486
9487 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9488
9489 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9490 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9491 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9492 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9493 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9494 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9495 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9496 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9497 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9498 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9499 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9500 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9501 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9502 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9503 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9504 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9505 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9506 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9507 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9508 instead.
9509
9510 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9511 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9512 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9513 rules which may be inserted.
9514
9515 Several types of actions are supported :
9516 - accept : the request is accepted
9517 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9518 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9519 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9520 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9521 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009522 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009523 - silent-drop
9524
9525 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9526 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9527 sections for a complete description.
9528
9529 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9530 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9531 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9532
9533 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9534 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9535 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9536 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9537 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9538
9539 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9540 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9541
9542 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9543 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9544 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9545
9546 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9547 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9548 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9549
9550 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9551 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9552 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9553
9554 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9555 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9556 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9557
9558 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9559
9560 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9561
9562
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009563tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9564 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 no | no | yes | yes
9567 Arguments :
9568 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9569 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9570 as explained at the top of this document.
9571
9572 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9573
9574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009575timeout check <timeout>
9576 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9577 established.
9578
9579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9580 yes | no | yes | yes
9581 Arguments:
9582 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9583 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9584 as explained at the top of this document.
9585
9586 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9587 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9588 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9589 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009590 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9591 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9592 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009593
9594 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9595 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9596
9597 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9598 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009599 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009600
9601 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9602 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9603 forget about it.
9604
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009605 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9606 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009607
9608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009609timeout client <timeout>
9610timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 yes | yes | yes | no
9614 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9617 as explained at the top of this document.
9618
9619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9623 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9624 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9625 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009626 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9627 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9628 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009629 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009630 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009631 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9632 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009633 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9634 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009635
9636 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9637 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9638 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9639 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9640 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9641 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9642
9643 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9644 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9645 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9646
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009647 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9648 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009649
9650
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009651timeout client-fin <timeout>
9652 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9654 yes | yes | yes | no
9655 Arguments :
9656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9658 as explained at the top of this document.
9659
9660 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9661 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9662 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9663 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9664 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9665 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9666 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9667 down in one direction.
9668
9669 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9670 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9671 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9672
9673 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9674
9675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009676timeout connect <timeout>
9677timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9678 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9680 yes | no | yes | yes
9681 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009682 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009683 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9684 as explained at the top of this document.
9685
9686 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009687 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009688 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009689 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009690 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9691 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009692
9693 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9694 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9695 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9696 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9697 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9698 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9699
9700 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9701 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9702 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9703
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009704 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9705 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009706
9707
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009708timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9709 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9711 yes | yes | yes | yes
9712 Arguments :
9713 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9714 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9715 as explained at the top of this document.
9716
9717 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9718 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9719 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9720 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9721 once the request has started to present itself.
9722
9723 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9724 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9725 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9726 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9727 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9728
9729 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9730 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9731 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9732 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9733
9734 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9735 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9736 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9737 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9738 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009739 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009740
9741 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9742 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9743 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9744 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9745
9746 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9747
9748
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009749timeout http-request <timeout>
9750 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009752 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009753 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9756 as explained at the top of this document.
9757
9758 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9759 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9760 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9761 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9762 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9763 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9764 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009765 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9766 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9767 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9768 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9769 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009770 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9771 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009772
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009773 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9774 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9775 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9776 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9777 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009778 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009779
9780 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9781 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9782 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9783 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9784 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9785
9786 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009787 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9788 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9789 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009790
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009791 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009792 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009793
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009794
9795timeout queue <timeout>
9796 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9798 yes | no | yes | yes
9799 Arguments :
9800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9802 as explained at the top of this document.
9803
9804 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9805 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9806 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9807 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9808 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9809
9810 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9811 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9812 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9813 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9814
9815 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9816
9817
9818timeout server <timeout>
9819timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9820 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9822 yes | no | yes | yes
9823 Arguments :
9824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9826 as explained at the top of this document.
9827
9828 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9829 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9830 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9831 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9832 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9833 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9834 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9835
9836 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9837 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9838 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9839 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9840 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009841 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009842 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009843 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9844 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9845 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9846 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009847
9848 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9849 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9850 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9851 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9852 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9853 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9854
9855 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9856 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9857 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9858
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009859 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009860
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009861
9862timeout server-fin <timeout>
9863 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9865 yes | no | yes | yes
9866 Arguments :
9867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9869 as explained at the top of this document.
9870
9871 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9872 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9873 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9874 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9875 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9876 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9877 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9878 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9879 situations, it should not be needed.
9880
9881 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9882 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9883 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9884
9885 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9886
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009887
9888timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009889 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 yes | yes | yes | yes
9892 Arguments :
9893 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9894 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9895 as explained at the top of this document.
9896
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009897 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9898 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9899 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9900 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901
9902 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9903 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9904 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9905 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009906 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009907
9908 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9909
9910
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009911timeout tunnel <timeout>
9912 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 yes | no | yes | yes
9915 Arguments :
9916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9918 as explained at the top of this document.
9919
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009920 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009921 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9922 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9923 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9924 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9925 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9926 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9927 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9928 specified.
9929
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009930 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9931 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9932 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9933 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9934 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9935 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9936 state.
9937
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009938 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9939 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9940 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9941 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9942 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9943
9944 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9945 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9946 forget about it.
9947
9948 Example :
9949 defaults http
9950 option http-server-close
9951 timeout connect 5s
9952 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009953 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009954 timeout server 30s
9955 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9956
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009957 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009958
9959
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009960transparent (deprecated)
9961 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009963 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964 Arguments : none
9965
9966 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9967 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9968 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9969 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9970 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9971 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9972 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9973 appropriate server.
9974
9975 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9976
9977 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9978 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9979
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009980 See also: "option transparent"
9981
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009982unique-id-format <string>
9983 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9985 yes | yes | yes | no
9986 Arguments :
9987 <string> is a log-format string.
9988
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009989 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9990 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9991 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9992 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009993
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009994 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9995 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9996 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9997 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9998 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9999 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10000 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10001 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010002
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010003 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10004 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010005
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010006 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010007
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010008 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010009
10010 will generate:
10011
10012 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10013
10014 See also: "unique-id-header"
10015
10016unique-id-header <name>
10017 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10019 yes | yes | yes | no
10020 Arguments :
10021 <name> is the name of the header.
10022
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010023 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10024 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010025
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010026 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010027
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010028 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010029 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10030
10031 will generate:
10032
10033 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10034
10035 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010036
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010037use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010038 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10040 no | yes | yes | no
10041 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010042 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10043 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010044
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010045 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10046 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010047
10048 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10049 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10050 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010051 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10052 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10053 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10054 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010055
10056 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10057 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10058 assign the backend.
10059
10060 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10061 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10062 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10063 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10064 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10065 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10066
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010067 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010068 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010069 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10070 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10071 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10072
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010073 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10074 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10075 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10076 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10077 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10078 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10079 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10080 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10081 cannot be forced from the request.
10082
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010083 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010084 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10085 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10086
10087 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10088 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010089
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010090
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010091use-server <server> if <condition>
10092use-server <server> unless <condition>
10093 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10095 no | no | yes | yes
10096 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010097 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010098
10099 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10100
10101 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10102 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10103 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10104
10105 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10106 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10107 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10108 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10109 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10110 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10111 matches will assign the server.
10112
10113 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10114 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10115 with the next rules until one matches.
10116
10117 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10118 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10119 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10120 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10121
10122 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10123 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10124 stripped.
10125
10126 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10127 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10128 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10129 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10130
10131 Example :
10132 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10133 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10134 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10135 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10136 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10137 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010138 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010139 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10140 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10141
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010142 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010143
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010144
101455. Bind and Server options
10146--------------------------
10147
10148The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10149depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10150settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10151written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10152described in this section.
10153
10154
101555.1. Bind options
10156-----------------
10157
10158The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10159as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10160no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10161parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10162while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10163provided immediately after the setting name.
10164
10165The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10166
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010167accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10168 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10169 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10170 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10171 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10172 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10173 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10174 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10175 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10176 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010177 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10178 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10179 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010180
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010181accept-proxy
10182 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010183 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10184 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010185 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10186 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10187 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10188 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10189 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10190 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10191 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010192 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10193 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010194
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010195alpn <protocols>
10196 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10197 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10198 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10199 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10200 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10201 initial NPN extension.
10202
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010203backlog <backlog>
10204 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10205 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10206
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010207curves <curves>
10208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10209 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10210 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10211 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10212 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10213 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10214
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010215ecdhe <named curve>
10216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010217 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10218 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010219
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010220ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10222 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10223 client's certificate.
10224
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010225ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10227 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10228 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10229 error is ignored.
10230
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010231ca-sign-file <cafile>
10232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10233 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10234 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10235 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10236 'generate-certificates' for details.
10237
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010238ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10240 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10241 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10242 'generate-certificates' for details.
10243
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010244ciphers <ciphers>
10245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10246 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010247 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010248 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10249 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10250
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010251crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10253 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10254 to verify client's certificate.
10255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010256crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10258 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10259 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10260 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10261 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10262 file.
10263
10264 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10265 are loaded.
10266
10267 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010268 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010269 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10270 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10271 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10272 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10273 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10274 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10275 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010276
10277 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10278 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10279 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10280 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010281 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10282 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010283
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010284 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010285
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010286 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10287 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010288 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010289 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10290 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10291 clients).
10292
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010293 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10294 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10295 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10296 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10297 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10298 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10299 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10300 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10301 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10302 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10303 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10304 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10305 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10306
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010307 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10308 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10309 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10310 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10311 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10312
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010313 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10314 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10315 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10316 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010317
10318 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10319 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10320 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10321 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10322 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10323 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10324 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10325 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10326 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10327
10328 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10329
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010330 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010331 a cert bundle.
10332
10333 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10334 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10335 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10336 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10337 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10338 provide multi-cert support.
10339
10340 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10341
10342 Filename | CN | SAN
10343 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10344 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010345 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010346 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10347 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10348
10349 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10350 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10351 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10352 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010353 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10354 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010355
10356 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10357 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10358
10359 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10360 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10361 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10362
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010363crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10365 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010366 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010367 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010368
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010369crt-list <file>
10370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010371 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10372 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010373
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010374 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10375
10376 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010377 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010378 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010379
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010380 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10381 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10382 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10383 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10384 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10385 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10386 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10387 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010388
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010389 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010390 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010391 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10392 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10393 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010394
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010395 crt-list file example:
10396 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010397 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010398 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010399 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010400
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010401defer-accept
10402 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10403 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10404 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10405 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10406 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10407 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10408 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10409 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10410 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10411 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10412 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10413
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010414force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010415 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010416 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010417 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010419
10420force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010422 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10423 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010424
10425force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010427 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10428 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010429
10430force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010432 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10433 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010434
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010435generate-certificates
10436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10437 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10438 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10439 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10440 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10441 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10442 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10443 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10444 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10445 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10446 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10447
10448 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10449 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10450 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10451 certificate is used many times.
10452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010453gid <gid>
10454 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10455 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10456 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10457 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10458 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10459
10460group <group>
10461 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10462 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10463 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10464 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10465 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10466
10467id <id>
10468 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10469 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10470 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10471 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10472
10473interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010474 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10475 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10476 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10477 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10478 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10479 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10480 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010481
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010482level <level>
10483 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10484 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10485 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10486 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10487 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10488 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10489 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10490 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10491 counters).
10492 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10493 all counters).
10494
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010495maxconn <maxconn>
10496 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10497 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10498 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10499 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10500 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10501 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10502 eat all memory.
10503
10504mode <mode>
10505 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10506 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10507 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10508 UNIX sockets.
10509
10510mss <maxseg>
10511 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10512 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10513 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10514 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10515 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10516 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10517 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10518 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10519 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10520 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10521 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10522
10523name <name>
10524 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10525 page.
10526
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010527namespace <name>
10528 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10529 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10530 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10531 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10532
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010533nice <nice>
10534 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10535 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10536 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10537 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10538 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10539 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10540 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10541 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10542 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10543 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10544 one for an RDP socket.
10545
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010546no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010548 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010549 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010550 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10551 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010552 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010553
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010554no-tls-tickets
10555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10556 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10557 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010558 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10559 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010560
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010561no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010563 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010564 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010565 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10566 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10567 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010568
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010569no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010571 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010572 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010573 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10574 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10575 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010576
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010577no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010579 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010580 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010581 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10582 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10583 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010584
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010585npn <protocols>
10586 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10587 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10588 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10589 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010590 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10591 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010592
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010593process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10594 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10595 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10596 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10597 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10598 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10599 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10600 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010601 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10602 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10603 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10604 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10605 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10606 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10607 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010608
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010609ssl
10610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010611 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010612 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10613 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10614 to deciphered contents.
10615
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010616strict-sni
10617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10618 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10619 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10620 See the "crt" option for more information.
10621
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010622tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010623 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010624 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10625 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010626 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010627 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10628 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10629 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10630 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10631 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10632 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10633 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10634
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010635tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010636 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010637 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10638 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10639 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10640 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10641 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10642 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10643 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010644 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10645 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10646 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010647
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010648tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10649 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10650 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10651 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10652 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10653 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10654 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10655 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10656 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10657 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10658 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10659
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010660transparent
10661 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10662 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10663 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10664 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10665 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10666 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10667 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10668 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10669 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10670 so check for support with your vendor.
10671
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010672v4v6
10673 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10674 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10675 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10676 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010677 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010678
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010679v6only
10680 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10681 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10682 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010683 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10684 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010686uid <uid>
10687 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10688 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10689 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10690 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10691 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10692
10693user <user>
10694 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10695 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10696 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10697 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10698 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10699
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010700verify [none|optional|required]
10701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10702 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10703 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10704 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10705 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010706 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10707 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10708 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10709 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010710
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200107115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010712------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010714The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10715which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10716arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10717settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10718after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10719Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10720address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010722 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010723 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010724
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010725Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10726keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010728The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010729
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010730addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010731 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010732 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10733 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10734 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10735 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10736 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010737
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010738agent-check
10739 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010740 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10741 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10742 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10743 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010744
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010745 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010746 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010747 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10748 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10749 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010750
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010751 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10752 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10753 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10754 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10755 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10756
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010757 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10758 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010759
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010760 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10761 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10762 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010763
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010764 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10765 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10766 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010767
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010768 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10769 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10770 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10771 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10772 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10773 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10774 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010776 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10777 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010778
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010779 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10780 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10781 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10782 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10783 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10784 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10785 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10786 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10787 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010788
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010789 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10790 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010791 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10792 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10793 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010794 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010795
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010796 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010797 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010798
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010799agent-send <string>
10800 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10801 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10802 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10803 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10804 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10805
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010806agent-inter <delay>
10807 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10808 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10809
10810 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10811 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10812 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10813 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10814 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10815 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10816 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10817 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10818 of backends use the same servers.
10819
10820 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10821
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010822agent-addr <addr>
10823 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10824
10825 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10826 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10827 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10828 hostname, it will be resolved.
10829
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010830agent-port <port>
10831 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10832
10833 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010835backup
10836 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10837 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10838 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10839 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010840 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10841 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010842
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010843ca-file <cafile>
10844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10845 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10846 server's certificate.
10847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010848check
10849 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010850 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10851 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10852 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10853 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10854 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10855 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10856 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010857 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10858 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010859 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10860 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010861
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010862check-send-proxy
10863 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10864 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10865 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10866 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10867 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10868 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10869 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10870
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010871check-ssl
10872 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10873 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10874 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10875 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010876 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010877 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10878 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10879 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010880 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10881 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010882
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010883ciphers <ciphers>
10884 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010885 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010886 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10887 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10888 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10889 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10890 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10891 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893cookie <value>
10894 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10895 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10896 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10897 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10898 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10899 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10900 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10901
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010902crl-file <crlfile>
10903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10904 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10905 to verify server's certificate.
10906
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010907crt <cert>
10908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10909 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10910 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10911 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10912 certificate request.
10913
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010914disabled
10915 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10916 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10917 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10918 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10919 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010920 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010921
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010922enabled
10923 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10924 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10925 default value.
10926 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10927 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010929error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010930 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10931 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10932 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010934 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010936fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010937 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10938 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10939 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10940
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010941force-sslv3
10942 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10943 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010944 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010945 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-sslv3", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010946
10947force-tlsv10
10948 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010949 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010950 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv10", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010951
10952force-tlsv11
10953 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010954 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010955 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv11", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010956
10957force-tlsv12
10958 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010959 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010960 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv12", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010962id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010963 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10964 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10965 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010966
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010967init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10968 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10969 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10970 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10971 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10972 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10973 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10974 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10975 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10976 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10977 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10978 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10979 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10980 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10981 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10982 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10983 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10984 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10985 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10986 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10987 historic behaviour.
10988
10989 Example:
10990 defaults
10991 # never fail on address resolution
10992 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010994inter <delay>
10995fastinter <delay>
10996downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010997 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10998 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10999 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11000 between checks depending on the server state :
11001
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011002 Server state | Interval used
11003 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11004 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11005 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11006 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11007 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11008 or yet unchecked. |
11009 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11010 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11011 | "inter" otherwise.
11012 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011014 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11015 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11016 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11017 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011018 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11019 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11020 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11021 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11022 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011024maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011025 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11026 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11027 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11028 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11029 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11030 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11031 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11032 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011034maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011035 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11036 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11037 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11038 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11039 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11040 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11041 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011043minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011044 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11045 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11046 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11047 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11048 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11049 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011050 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011051 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011052
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011053namespace <name>
11054 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11055 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11056 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11057 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11058
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011059no-agent-check
11060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11062 default value.
11063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11064 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11065
11066no-backup
11067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11069 default value.
11070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11071 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11072
11073no-check
11074 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11075 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11076 default value.
11077 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11078 "default-server" "check" setting.
11079
11080no-check-ssl
11081 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11082 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11083 default value.
11084 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11085 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11086
11087no-force-sslv3
11088 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-sslv3"
11089 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11090 default value.
11091 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11092 "default-server" "force-sslv3" setting.
11093
11094no-force-tlsv10
11095 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv10"
11096 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11097 default value.
11098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11099 "default-server" "force-tlsv10" setting.
11100
11101no-force-tlsv11
11102 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv11"
11103 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11104 default value.
11105 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11106 "default-server" "force-tlsv11" setting.
11107
11108no-force-tlsv12
11109 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv12"
11110 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11111 default value.
11112 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11113 "default-server" "force-tlsv12" setting.
11114
11115no-send-proxy
11116 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11117 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11118 default value.
11119 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11120 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11121
11122no-send-proxy-v2
11123 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11124 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11125 default value.
11126 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11127 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11128
11129no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11130 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11131 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11132 default value.
11133 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11134 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11135
11136no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11137 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11138 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11139 default value.
11140 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11141 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11142
11143no-ssl
11144 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11145 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11146 default value.
11147 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11148 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11149
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011150no-ssl-reuse
11151 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11152 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11153 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11154 and for paranoid users.
11155
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011156no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011157 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11158 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011159 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011160
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011161no-tls-tickets
11162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11163 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11164 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011165 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11166 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011167 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011168
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011169no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011170 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011171 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11172 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011173 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11174 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011175 See also "tlsv10", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011176
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011177no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011178 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011179 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11180 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011181 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11182 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011183 See also "tlsv11", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011184
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011185no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011186 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011187 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11188 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011189 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11190 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011191 See also "tlsv12", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011192
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011193no-verifyhost
11194 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11195 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11196 default value.
11197 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11198 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011199
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011200non-stick
11201 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11202 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11203 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011205observe <mode>
11206 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11207 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11208 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11209 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11210 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11211 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011212 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011213
11214 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011216on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011217 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11218 Currently, four modes are available:
11219 - fastinter: force fastinter
11220 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11221 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11222 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11223 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11224
11225 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11226
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011227on-marked-down <action>
11228 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11229 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011230 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11231 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11232 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11233 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11234 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11235 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11236 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11237 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011238
11239 Actions are disabled by default
11240
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011241on-marked-up <action>
11242 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11243 Currently one action is available:
11244 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11245 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11246 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11247 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11248 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11249 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11250 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11251 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11252
11253 Actions are disabled by default
11254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011255port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011256 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11257 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11258 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11259 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11260 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11261 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11262
11263redir <prefix>
11264 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11265 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11266 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11267 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11268 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11269 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11270 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11271 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011272 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11274 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11275 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11276 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11277 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11278
11279 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011281rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011282 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11283 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11284 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11285
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011286resolve-prefer <family>
11287 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11288 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11289 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11290 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11291
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011292 Default value: ipv6
11293
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011294 Example:
11295
11296 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011297
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011298resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11299 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11300 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011301 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011302 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11303 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11304 configured network, another address is selected.
11305
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011306 Example:
11307
11308 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011309
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011310resolvers <id>
11311 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11312 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011313 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11314 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11315 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11316 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011318 Example:
11319
11320 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011321
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011322 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011323
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011324send-proxy
11325 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11326 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11327 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11328 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011329 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11330 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11331 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11332 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11333 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11334 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11335 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11336 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11337 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11338 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011339 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11340 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011341
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011342send-proxy-v2
11343 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11344 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11345 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11346 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11347 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011348 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11349 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11350 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011351
11352send-proxy-v2-ssl
11353 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11354 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11355 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11356 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11357 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11358 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11359 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011360 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11361 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011362
11363send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11364 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11365 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11366 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11367 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11368 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11369 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11370 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11371 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011372 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11373 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011375slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011376 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11377 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11378 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11379 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11380 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11381 parameters :
11382
11383 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11384 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11385
11386 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11387 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11388 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11389 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11390
11391 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11392 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11393 seen as failed.
11394
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011395sni <expression>
11396 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11397 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11398 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11399 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11400 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11401
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011402source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011403source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011404source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011405 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11406 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11407 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11408 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11409
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011410 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11411 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11412 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11413 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11414 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11415 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11416 server.
11417
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011418 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11419 specifying the source address without port(s).
11420
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011421ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011422 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11423 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11424 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11425 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11426 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11427 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011428 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11429 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011430
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011431sslv3
11432 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-sslv3"
11433 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11434 default value.
11435 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11436 "default-server" "no-sslv3" setting.
11437
11438ssl-reuse
11439 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11440 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11441 default value.
11442 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11443 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11444
11445stick
11446 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11447 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11448 default value.
11449 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11450 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011451
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011452tcp-ut <delay>
11453 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11454 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11455 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011456 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011457 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11458 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11459 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11460 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11461 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11462 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11463 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11464 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11465 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011467track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011468 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11469 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11470 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11471 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011472 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011474tlsv10
11475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv10"
11476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11477 default value.
11478 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11479 "default-server" "no-tlsv10" setting.
11480
11481tlsv11
11482 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv11"
11483 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11484 default value.
11485 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11486 "default-server" "no-tlsv11" setting.
11487
11488tlsv12
11489 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv12"
11490 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11491 default value.
11492 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11493 "default-server" "no-tlsv12" setting.
11494
11495tls-tickets
11496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11498 default value.
11499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11500 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011501
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011502verify [none|required]
11503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011504 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11505 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11506 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11507 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011508 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11509 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11510 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011511
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011512verifyhost <hostname>
11513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11514 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11515 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11516 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11517 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11518 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011519 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011521weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011522 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11523 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11524 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011525 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11526 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11527 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11528 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11529 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11530 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011531
11532
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115335.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11534-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011535
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011536HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11537using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11538configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011539This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11540can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11541workload.
11542This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11543resolution at run time.
11544Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11545carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11546
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011547Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11548health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11549
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011550
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115515.3.1. Global overview
11552----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011553
11554As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11555different steps of the process life:
11556
11557 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11558 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11559 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11560
11561 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11562 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11563 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11564
11565A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11566 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11567 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11568 resolution to know this new IP.
11569
11570A few things important to notice:
11571 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11572 first valid response.
11573
11574 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11575 servers return an error.
11576
11577
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115785.3.2. The resolvers section
11579----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011580
11581This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11582HAProxy.
11583There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11584many name servers.
11585
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011586When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11587uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11588is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11589answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11590
11591When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11592used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11593
11594Two types of behavior can be applied:
11595 1. stop DNS resolution
11596 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11597 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11598 1. ANY query type
11599 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11600 server's parameter
11601 3. remaining family type
11602
11603HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11604 - invalid DNS response packet
11605 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11606 - NX domain
11607 - Query refused by server
11608 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11609
11610HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11611 - no Answer records in the response
11612 - DNS response truncated
11613 - Error in DNS response
11614 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11615 - name server timeout
11616
11617For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11618 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11619 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11620 applied;
11621 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11622 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11623 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11624 stops resolution.
11625
11626
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011627resolvers <resolvers id>
11628 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11629
11630A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11631
11632nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11633 DNS server description:
11634 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11635 <ip> : IP address of the server
11636 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11637
11638hold <status> <period>
11639 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11640 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011641 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11642 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011643 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11644 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11645 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11646
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011647 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011648
11649 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11650 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11651 the healch check.
11652
11653resolve_retries <nb>
11654 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11655 giving up.
11656 Default value: 3
11657
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011658 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11659 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11660 type.
11661
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011662timeout <event> <time>
11663 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11664 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11665 events available are:
11666 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11667 been received.
11668 Default value: 1s
11669 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11670 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011672 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011673
11674 resolvers mydns
11675 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11676 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11677 resolve_retries 3
11678 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011679 hold other 30s
11680 hold refused 30s
11681 hold nx 30s
11682 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011683 hold valid 10s
11684
11685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116866. HTTP header manipulation
11687---------------------------
11688
11689In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11690response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11691request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11692which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011693against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011694
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011695If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11696to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11697but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11698HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11699stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11700because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11701a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11702still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011704This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11705in section 4.2 :
11706
11707 - reqadd <string>
11708 - reqallow <search>
11709 - reqiallow <search>
11710 - reqdel <search>
11711 - reqidel <search>
11712 - reqdeny <search>
11713 - reqideny <search>
11714 - reqpass <search>
11715 - reqipass <search>
11716 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11717 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11718 - reqtarpit <search>
11719 - reqitarpit <search>
11720 - rspadd <string>
11721 - rspdel <search>
11722 - rspidel <search>
11723 - rspdeny <search>
11724 - rspideny <search>
11725 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11726 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11727
11728With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11729is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11730parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11731prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11732Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11733
11734 \t for a tab
11735 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11736 \n for a new line (LF)
11737 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11738 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11739 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11740 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11741 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11742
11743The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11744portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11745above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11746regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
117479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11748is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11749
11750The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11751after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11752
11753Notes related to these keywords :
11754---------------------------------
11755 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11756 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11757 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11758
11759 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11760 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11761 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11762
11763 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11764 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11765 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11766 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11767 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11768
11769 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11770 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11771 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11772 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11773 useless headers before adding new ones.
11774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011775 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011776 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11777
11778 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11779 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11780 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11781
11782 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11783 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011784 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011785
11786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117877. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11788----------------------------------
11789
11790Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11791client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11792The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11793these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11794but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11795data called patterns.
11796
11797
117987.1. ACL basics
11799---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011800
11801The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11802content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11803from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11804simple :
11805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011807 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011808 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11809 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011811The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11812adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011813
11814In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011817
11818This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11819Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11820and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011821an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11822conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11823as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11824are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011825
11826ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11827'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11828which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11829
11830There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11831performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11834specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11835this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011836methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11837ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838
11839Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11840 - boolean
11841 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11842 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11843 - string
11844 - data block
11845
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011846Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11847converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11848would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11849The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11850which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11851
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011852Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11853keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11854fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11855which are summarized in the table below :
11856
11857 +---------------------+-----------------+
11858 | Sample or converter | Default |
11859 | output type | matching method |
11860 +---------------------+-----------------+
11861 | boolean | bool |
11862 +---------------------+-----------------+
11863 | integer | int |
11864 +---------------------+-----------------+
11865 | ip | ip |
11866 +---------------------+-----------------+
11867 | string | str |
11868 +---------------------+-----------------+
11869 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11870 +---------------------+-----------------+
11871
11872Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11873matching method, see below.
11874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011875The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11876 - boolean
11877 - integer or integer range
11878 - IP address / network
11879 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11880 - regular expression
11881 - hex block
11882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011883The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11884
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011885 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11886 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011888 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011889 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011890 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011891 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11894read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11895if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11896lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11897will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11898beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11899a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11900lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11901exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11902
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011903The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11904parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11905ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11906a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11907check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11908
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011909The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11910socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11911file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011913Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11914loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11915
11916 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11917
11918In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11919the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11920case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11921as well.
11922
11923The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11924sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11925do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11926methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11927is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11928obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11929followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11930default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11931that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11932string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11933
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011934The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11935By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11936string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11937resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11938server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11939waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11940flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11941function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011943There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11944sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11945be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011946
11947 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11948 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011949 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11950 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11951 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11952 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011953
11954 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11955 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011957
11958 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011959 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011960
11961 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011962 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011963
11964 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11965 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11966
11967 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11968 binary or string samples.
11969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011970 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11971 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011973 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11974 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11975 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11978 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011980 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11981 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11984 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011986 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11987 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011988 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011990 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11991 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11992 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011993
11994For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11995request, it is possible to do :
11996
11997 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11998
11999In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12000buffer, one would use the following acl :
12001
12002 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12003
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012004On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12005possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12006
12007 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12010criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12011method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12012to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12013criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12014the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012017the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12018For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12021 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12022 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12023 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012024
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012025
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012026The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12027types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12028combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12029brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12030default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012032 +-------------------------------------------------+
12033 | Input sample type |
12034 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012035 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12037 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12038 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012039 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012041 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012043 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012045 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012047 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012048 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012049 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012050 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012051 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012053 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012055 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012057 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012059 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12061 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012063
12064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120657.1.1. Matching booleans
12066------------------------
12067
12068In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12069Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12070When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12071that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12072
12073Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12074return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12075"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12076
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120787.1.2. Matching integers
12079------------------------
12080
12081Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12082enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12083to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12084
12085Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12086matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12087lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012088
12089For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12090unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12091representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12092
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012093As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12094two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12095instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12096ranges and operators.
12097
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012098For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012099operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12100Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12101of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012103Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012104
12105 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12106 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12107 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12108 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12109 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012111For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012112
12113 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12114
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012115This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12116
12117 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12118
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121207.1.3. Matching strings
12121-----------------------
12122
12123String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12124different forms :
12125
12126 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12127 patterns ;
12128
12129 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12130 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12131
12132 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12133 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12134
12135 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12136 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12137
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012138 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012139 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12140 matches.
12141
12142 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12143 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12144 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012145
12146String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12147exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12148characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12149string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12150to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012151before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012152
12153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121547.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12155---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012156
12157Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12158they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12159possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12160passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12161the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012162the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12163match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012164
12165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121667.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12167-------------------------------------
12168
12169It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12170not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12171a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12172to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12173digits may be used upper or lower case.
12174
12175Example :
12176 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12177 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12178
12179
121807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12181---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012182
12183IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12184netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12185within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012186host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012187difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12188at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12189does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12190parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012191
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012192The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12193abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12194
12195 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12196 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12197 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12198 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12199 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12200 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12201 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12202 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12203
12204Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12205192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12206
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012207IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12208Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12209trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12210IPv6 patterns.
12211
12212HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12213following situations :
12214 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12215 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12216 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12217 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12218 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12219 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12220 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12221 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12222 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12223 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225
122267.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12227----------------------------------
12228
12229Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12230combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12231
12232 - AND (implicit)
12233 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12234 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012236A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12241indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12244"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12245requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12246is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12247
12248 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012249 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12250 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12251 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252
12253To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12254and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12255
12256 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12257 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12258 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12259 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12260
12261 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12262 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12263 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12264 use_backend www if host_www
12265
12266It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12267expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12268be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12269the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12270
12271 The following rule :
12272
12273 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012274 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012275
12276 Can also be written that way :
12277
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012278 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279
12280It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12281to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12282simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12283sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12284good use is the following :
12285
12286 With named ACLs :
12287
12288 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12289 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12290 monitor fail if site_dead
12291
12292 With anonymous ACLs :
12293
12294 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12295
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012296See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12297keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012298
12299
123007.3. Fetching samples
12301---------------------
12302
12303Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12304against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12305sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12306ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12307of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12308available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12309
12310This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12311Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12312compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12313deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12314
12315The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12316matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12317method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12318indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12319
12320As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12321when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12322mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12323the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12324ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12325
12326Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12327multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12328when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12329incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12330are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12331is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12332all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12333
12334Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12335 - name
12336 - name(arg1)
12337 - name(arg1,arg2)
12338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012339
123407.3.1. Converters
12341-----------------
12342
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012343Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12344of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12345is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12346was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12347has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12348unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12349
12350These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12351sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12352the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12353support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012354
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012355A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12356support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12357supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12358(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12359bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012362
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001236351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12364 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12365 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12366 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12367 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12368 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12369
12370 Example :
12371 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12372 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12373 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12374 frontend http-in
12375 bind *:8081
12376 default_backend servers
12377 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12378 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012380add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012381 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012382 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012383 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12384 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012385 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012386 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12387 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12388 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12389 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12390 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012391 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012392
12393and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012394 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012395 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012396 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12397 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012398 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012399 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12400 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12401 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12403 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012404 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012405
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012406base64
12407 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12408 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12409 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12410
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012411bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012412 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012413 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12414 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12415 presence of a flag).
12416
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012417bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12418 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12419 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012420 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012421
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012422cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012423 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12424 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012425
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012426crc32([<avalanche>])
12427 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12428 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12429 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12430 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12431 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12432 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12433 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12434 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12435 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12436 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12437 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12438
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012439da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012440 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12441 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12442 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12443 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012444 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012445 configuration language.
12446
12447 Example:
12448 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012449 bind *:8881
12450 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012451 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012452
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012453debug
12454 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12455 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12456 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012458div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012459 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12460 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012461 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012462 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12463 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012464 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012465 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12466 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12467 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12468 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12469 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012470 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012471
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012472djb2([<avalanche>])
12473 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12474 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12475 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12476 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12477 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12478 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12479 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012480 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12481 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012482
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012483even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012484 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012485 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12486
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012487field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12488 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12489 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12490 list of chars.
12491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012492hex
12493 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12494 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12495 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12496 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012498http_date([<offset>])
12499 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12500 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12501 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12502 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12503 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12504 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012505
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012506in_table(<table>)
12507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12509 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12510 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12511 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12512
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012513ipmask(<mask>)
12514 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12515 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12516 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12517 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12518
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012519json([<input-code>])
12520 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12521 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012522 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012523 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12524 of errors:
12525 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12526 bytes, ...)
12527 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12528 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12529
12530 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12531 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12532 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12533 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12534 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12535 are :
12536 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12537 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12538 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12539 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12540 error ;
12541 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12542 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12543
12544 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12545 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12546
12547 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012548 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012549 capture request header user-agent len 150
12550 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012551
12552 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12553 GET / HTTP/1.0
12554 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12555
12556 Output log:
12557 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012559language(<value>[,<default>])
12560 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12561 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12562 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12563 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12564 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12565 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12566 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12567 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12568 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12569 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12570 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12571 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012573 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012575 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12576 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012578 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12579 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12580 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12581 use_backend spanish if es
12582 use_backend french if fr
12583 use_backend english if en
12584 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012585
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012586lower
12587 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12588 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12589 type. The result is of type string.
12590
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012591ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12592 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12593 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12594 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12595 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12596 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12597 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12598
12599 Example :
12600
12601 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12602 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12603 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12604
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012605map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12606map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12607map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12608 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12609 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12610 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12611 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12612 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12613 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12614 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12615 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012616
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012617 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12618 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12619 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012620
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012621 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012622 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012623
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012624 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12625 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12626 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12627 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012628 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12629 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012630 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12631 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12632 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12633 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12634 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12635 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12636 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12637 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012638 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12639 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12640 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012641 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12642 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12643 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12644 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12645 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012646
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012647 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12648 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12649 the corresponding match text.
12650
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012651 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12652 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12653 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12654 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12655 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012656
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012657 Example :
12658
12659 # this is a comment and is ignored
12660 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12661 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12662 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12663 | | | `---------- value
12664 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12665 | `---------------------------- key
12666 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12667
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012668mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012669 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12670 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012671 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012672 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012673 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012674 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12675 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12676 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12677 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12678 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012679 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012680
12681mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012682 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012683 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12684 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012685 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012686 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012687 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12690 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12692 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012693 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012694
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012695nbsrv
12696 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12697 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12698 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12699 map lookup.
12700
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012701neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012702 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12703 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12704 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12705 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012706
12707not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012708 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012709 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12710 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12711 absence of a flag).
12712
12713odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012714 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012715 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12716
12717or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012718 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012719 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012720 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12721 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012722 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012723 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12724 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12725 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12726 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12727 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012728 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012729
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012730regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012731 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12732 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12733 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12734 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12735 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12736 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12737 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12738 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12739 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12740 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012741 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12742 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12743 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12744 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012745
12746 Example :
12747
12748 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12749 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12750 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12751 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12752
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012753capture-req(<id>)
12754 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12755 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12756
12757 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012758 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12759 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012760
12761capture-res(<id>)
12762 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12763 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12764
12765 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012766 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12767 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012768
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012769sdbm([<avalanche>])
12770 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12771 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12772 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12773 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12774 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12775 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12776 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012777 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12778 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012779
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012780set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012781 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12782 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12783 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012787 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012788 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012791 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012792
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012793sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012794 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12795 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012796 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012797 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12798 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012802 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012806 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012807
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012808table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12812 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12813 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12814 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12815
12816
12817table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12821 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12822 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12823 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12824
12825table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12829 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12830 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12831
12832table_conn_cur(<table>)
12833 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12834 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12835 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12836 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12837 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12838
12839table_conn_rate(<table>)
12840 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12841 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12842 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12843 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12844 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12845
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012846table_gpt0(<table>)
12847 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12848 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12849 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12850 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12851 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12852
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012853table_gpc0(<table>)
12854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12856 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12857 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12858 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12859
12860table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12864 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12865 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12866 sample fetch keyword.
12867
12868table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12872 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12873 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12874
12875table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12878 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12879 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12880 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12881 keyword.
12882
12883table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12887 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12888 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12889
12890table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12891 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12892 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12893 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12894 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12895 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12896 keyword.
12897
12898table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12899 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12900 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12901 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12902 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12903 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12904 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12905 keyword.
12906
12907table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12911 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12912 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12913 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12914 keyword.
12915
12916table_server_id(<table>)
12917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12920 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12921 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12922 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12923
12924table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12928 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12929 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12930 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12931 keyword.
12932
12933table_sess_rate(<table>)
12934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12937 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12938 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12939 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12940 keyword.
12941
12942table_trackers(<table>)
12943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12946 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12947 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12948 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12949 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12950 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12951 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12952 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12953
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012954upper
12955 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12956 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12957 type. The result is of type string.
12958
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012959url_dec
12960 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12961 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12962
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012963unset-var(<var name>)
12964 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12965 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12966 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12967 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12968 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12969 response),
12970 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12971 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12973 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12974
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012975utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12976 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12977 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12978 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12979 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12980 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12981 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12982
12983 Example :
12984
12985 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12986 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12987 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12988
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012989word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12990 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12991 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12992
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012993wt6([<avalanche>])
12994 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12995 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12996 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12997 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12998 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12999 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13000 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013001 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13002 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013003
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013004xor(<value>)
13005 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013006 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013007 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013008 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013009 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013010 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13011 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013012 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013013 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13014 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013015 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013016 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013017
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013018xxh32([<seed>])
13019 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13020 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13021 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13022 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13023 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13024 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13025 as cryptographically secure.
13026
13027xxh64([<seed>])
13028 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13029 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13030 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13031 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13032 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13033 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13034 as cryptographically secure.
13035
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130377.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038--------------------------------------------
13039
13040A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13041not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13042"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13043The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13044
13045always_false : boolean
13046 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13047 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13048
13049always_true : boolean
13050 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13051 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13052
13053avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013054 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013055 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13056 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13057 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13058 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13059 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13060 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13061 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13062 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13063 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13064 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13065 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13066 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13067 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013069be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013070 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13071 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13072 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13073 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13074 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013076be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13078 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13079 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13080 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13081 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13082 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013083
13084 Example :
13085 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13086 backend dynamic
13087 mode http
13088 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13089 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013090
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013091bin(<hexa>) : bin
13092 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13093 of the string.
13094
13095bool(<bool>) : bool
13096 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13097 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013101 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13103 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013104
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013105 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013106 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013107 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13108
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013109 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13110 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013111
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013112 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013113 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013115 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13116 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013118 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013119
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013120 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13121 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013123 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013124
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013125date([<offset>]) : integer
13126 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13127 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13128 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13129 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013130 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13131
13132 Example :
13133
13134 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13135 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013136
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013137env(<name>) : string
13138 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13139 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13140 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13141 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13142 certain way.
13143
13144 Examples :
13145 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13146 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13147
13148 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13149 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13152 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013153 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13154 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13156 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13157 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13158 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13159 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013160
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013161fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13162 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13163 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13164 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013166fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13167 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13168 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13169 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13170 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13171 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13172 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13173 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13174 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013175
13176 Example :
13177 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13178 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13179 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13180 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13181 frontend mail
13182 bind :25
13183 mode tcp
13184 maxconn 100
13185 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13186 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13187 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13188 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013189
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013190hostname : string
13191 Returns the system hostname.
13192
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013193int(<integer>) : signed integer
13194 Returns a signed integer.
13195
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013196ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13197 Returns an ipv4.
13198
13199ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13200 Returns an ipv6.
13201
13202meth(<method>) : method
13203 Returns a method.
13204
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013205nbproc : integer
13206 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13207 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13208 and debugging purposes.
13209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13212 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13213 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013214 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13215 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13216 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013217
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013218proc : integer
13219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13220 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13221 debugging purposes.
13222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013224 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13225 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13226 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13228 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13229 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13230 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13231 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13232
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013233rand([<range>]) : integer
13234 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13235 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13236 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13237 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13238 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13242 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13243 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13244 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13245 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13246 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13247 methods.
13248
13249srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13250 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13251 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13252 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13253 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13254 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13255 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13256 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13257
13258srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13259 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13260 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013261 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13263 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13264 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13265 overloading servers).
13266
13267 Example :
13268 # Redirect to a separate back
13269 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13270 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13271 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13272
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013273stopping : boolean
13274 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13275 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13276 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13277
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013278str(<string>) : string
13279 Returns a string.
13280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13282 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13283 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13284
13285table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13286 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13287 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13288 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13289
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013290var(<var-name>) : undefined
13291 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013292 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13293 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013297 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013301 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013302
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133037.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304----------------------------------
13305
13306The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13307closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13308methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13309sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13310TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013311the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13312counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13313"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013314argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13315the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13316this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317
13318be_id : integer
13319 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13320 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13321
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013322be_name : string
13323 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13324 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326dst : ip
13327 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13328 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13329 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13330 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13331 RFC 4291.
13332
13333dst_conn : integer
13334 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13335 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13336 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13337 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13338 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13339 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13340 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13341 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013342
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013343dst_is_local : boolean
13344 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13345 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13346 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13347 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13348 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13349 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13350 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13351 it only once per connection.
13352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353dst_port : integer
13354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13355 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13356 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13357 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13358 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13359 an HTTP header.
13360
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013361fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13362 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13363 header.
13364
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013365fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13366 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13367 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13368 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13369 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13370 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13371 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13372
13373fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13374 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13375 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13376 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13377 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13378 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13379 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13380
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013381fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13382 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13383 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13384 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13385 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13386
13387fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13388 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13389 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13390 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13391 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13392
13393fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13394 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13395 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13396 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13397 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13398
13399fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13400 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13401 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13402 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13403 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13404
13405fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13406 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13407 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13408 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13409 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13410
13411fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13412 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13413 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13414 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13415 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013417fe_id : integer
13418 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013419 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13421
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013422fe_name : string
13423 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13424 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13425 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013427sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013428sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13429sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13430sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013431 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13432 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13433 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013435sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013436sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13437sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13438sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013439 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13440 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13441 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013443sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013444sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13445sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13446sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013447 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13448 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013449 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13450 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13451 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013452
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013453 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013454 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13455 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013456 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13457 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13458 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013459 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13460 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13461
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013462sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013463sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13464sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13465sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013466 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13467 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013469sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013470sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13471sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13472sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013473 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13474 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13475 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013477sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013478sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13479sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13480sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013481 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13482 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13483 See also src_conn_rate.
13484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013485sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013486sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13487sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13488sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013489 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013490 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013491
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013492sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13493sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13494sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13495sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13496 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13497 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013499sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013500sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13501sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13502sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013503 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13504 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13505 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013506 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13507 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13508 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013509
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013510sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013511sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13512sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13513sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013514 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13515 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13516 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013518sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013519sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13520sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13521sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013522 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13523 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13524 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13525 src_http_err_rate.
13526
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013527sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013528sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13529sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13530sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013531 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13532 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13533 src_http_req_cnt.
13534
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013535sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013536sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13537sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13538sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013539 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13540 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13541 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13542 src_http_req_rate.
13543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013544sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013545sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13546sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13547sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013548 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013549 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13550 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13551 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13552 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013553
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013554 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013555 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13556 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013557 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013559sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013560sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13561sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13562sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013563 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13564 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13565 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013567sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013568sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13569sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13570sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013571 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13572 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13573 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013575sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013576sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13577sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13578sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013579 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13580 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13581 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13582 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013583 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013584 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13585
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013586sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013587sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13588sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13589sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013590 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13591 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13592 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13593 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13594 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013595 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013596
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013597sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013598sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13599sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13600sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013601 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13602 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13603 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13604
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013605sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013606sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13607sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13608sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013609 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13610 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013611 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013612 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13613 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013614 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13615 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13616 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013618so_id : integer
13619 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13620 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13621 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623src : ip
13624 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13625 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13626 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13627 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013628 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13629 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13630 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13631 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013632
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013633 Example:
13634 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13635 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13638 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13639 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13640 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013641 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013643src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13644 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13645 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013646 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013647 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13650 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13651 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13652 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13653 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13654 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13655 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013656
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013657 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013658 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13659 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13660 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13661 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013662 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013663 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13664 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013667 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013668 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013669 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013670 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013673 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13675 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013676 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013678src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13679 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13680 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13681 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013682 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013684src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013685 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013686 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013687 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013688 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013689
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013690src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13691 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13692 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13693 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13694 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013696src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013697 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013699 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13700 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013701 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13702 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13703 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13706 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13707 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013708 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013709 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013710 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13713 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13714 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13715 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13716 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013717 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13720 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13721 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13722 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013723 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13726 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13727 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13728 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013729 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013730 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13733 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13734 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13735 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013736 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013737 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13738 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013739
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013740 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013741 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013742 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013743 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013744
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013745src_is_local : boolean
13746 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13747 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13748 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13749 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13750 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13751 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13752 once per connection.
13753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013754src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013755 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13756 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13757 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13758 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13759 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013762 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13763 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13764 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13765 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13766 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768src_port : integer
13769 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13770 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13771 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13772 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13775 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013776 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13777 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13778 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013779 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13782 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13783 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13784 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13785 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013786 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13789 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13790 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13791 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13792 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13793 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13794 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13795 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13796 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013797
13798 Example :
13799 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13800 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13801 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13802 listen ssh
13803 bind :22
13804 mode tcp
13805 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013806 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013808 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810srv_id : integer
13811 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13812 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13813 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138157.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013818The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13819closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13820when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13821usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013822future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013823
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001382451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13825 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13826 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13827 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13828 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13829 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13830
13831 Example :
13832 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13833 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13834 # the request.
13835 frontend http-in
13836 bind *:8081
13837 default_backend servers
13838 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13839 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13840
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013841ssl_bc : boolean
13842 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13843 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13844 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13845
13846ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13847 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13848 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13849
13850ssl_bc_cipher : string
13851 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13852 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13853
13854ssl_bc_protocol : string
13855 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13856 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13857
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013858ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013859 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013860 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13861 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013862
13863ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13864 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13865 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13866 if session was reused or not.
13867
13868ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13869 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13870 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013872ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13873 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13874 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13875 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13876 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13877 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013879ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13880 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13881 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13882 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13883 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013884
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013885ssl_c_der : binary
13886 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13887 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13888 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890ssl_c_err : integer
13891 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13892 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13893 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13894 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13895 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013897ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13898 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13899 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13900 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13901 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13902 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13903 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13904 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13905 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013907ssl_c_key_alg : string
13908 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13909 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13910 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912ssl_c_notafter : string
13913 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13914 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13915 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013917ssl_c_notbefore : string
13918 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13919 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13920 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13923 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13924 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13925 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13926 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13927 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13928 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13929 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13930 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932ssl_c_serial : binary
13933 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13934 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13935 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13938 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13939 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13940 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013941 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13942 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13943
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013944 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013945 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13948 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13949 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13950 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013952ssl_c_used : boolean
13953 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13954 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956ssl_c_verify : integer
13957 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13958 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13959 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13960 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962ssl_c_version : integer
13963 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13964 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013965
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013966ssl_f_der : binary
13967 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13968 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13969 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013971ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13972 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13973 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13974 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13975 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013976 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13978 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13979 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981ssl_f_key_alg : string
13982 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13983 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13984 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986ssl_f_notafter : string
13987 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13988 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13989 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013991ssl_f_notbefore : string
13992 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13993 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13994 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13997 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13998 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13999 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14000 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14001 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14002 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14003 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14004 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006ssl_f_serial : binary
14007 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14008 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14009 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014010
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014011ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14012 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14013 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14014 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14017 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14018 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14019 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021ssl_f_version : integer
14022 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14023 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14024
14025ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014026 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14027 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14028 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030 Example :
14031 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14032 listen http-https
14033 bind :80
14034 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14035 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14036
14037ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14038 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14039 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14040
14041ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014042 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14044 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14045 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14046 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14047 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14048 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14049 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14050 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052ssl_fc_cipher : string
14053 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14054 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014055
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014056ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14057 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14058 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014059 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014060
14061ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14062 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14063 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014064 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014065
14066ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14067 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14068 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14069 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14070 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14071 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14072 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14073
14074ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14075 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14076 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014077 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014080 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14081 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014082 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14083 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14084 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14085 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14088 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014089 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14090 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14091 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14092 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014093
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014094ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014095 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14096 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014099 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14101 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14102 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14103 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14104 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14105 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14106 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108ssl_fc_protocol : string
14109 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14110 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014111
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014112ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014113 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014114 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14115 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14118 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14119 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14120 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14121 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014123ssl_fc_sni : string
14124 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14125 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14126 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14127 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14128 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14129
14130 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14131 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14132 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014133 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14134 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14138 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014140ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14141 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14142 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014143
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14149sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14150only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14151For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14152be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14153can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14154sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14155for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14156content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014158payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14159 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14160 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14161 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014163payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14164 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14165 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14166 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168req.len : integer
14169req_len : integer (deprecated)
14170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14171 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14172 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14173 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14174 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14175 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14176 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14177 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14180 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014181 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14182 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14183 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14184 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186 ACL alternatives :
14187 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14190 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14191 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14192 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14193 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195 ACL alternatives :
14196 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200req.proto_http : boolean
14201req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14202 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14203 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14204 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14205 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14206 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14207 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14208 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 Example:
14211 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14212 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14213 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014214 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014216req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14217rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14218 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14219 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14220 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14221 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14222 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14223 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14224 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014226 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14227 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14228 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14229 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14230 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14231 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233 ACL derivatives :
14234 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236 Example :
14237 listen tse-farm
14238 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14239 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14240 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14241 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14242 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14243 persist rdp-cookie
14244 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14245 # This is only useful makes sense if
14246 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14247 stick-table type string size 204800
14248 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14249 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14250 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14253 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14256rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14257 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14258 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14259 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14260 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262 ACL derivatives :
14263 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014264
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014265req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14266 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14267 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014268 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14269 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14270 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14271 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14272 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14275req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14276 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14277 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14278 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14279 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14280 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14281 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14282 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284req.ssl_sni : string
14285req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14286 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14287 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14288 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14289 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14290 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14291 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14292 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14293 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14294 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14295 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14296 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14297 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299 ACL derivatives :
14300 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302 Examples :
14303 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14304 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14305 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14306 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14307 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014308
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014309req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14310 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14311 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14312 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14313 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14314 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14315 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14316 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14317 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14318 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320req.ssl_ver : integer
14321req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14322 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14323 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14324 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14325 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14326 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14327 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14328 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14329 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14330 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332 ACL derivatives :
14333 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014334
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014335res.len : integer
14336 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14337 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14338 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14339 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14340 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14341 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14342 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14343 content inspection.
14344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14346 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014347 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14348 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14349 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14350 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14353 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14354 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14355 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14356 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014359
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014360res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14361rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14362 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14363 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14364 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14365 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14366 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14367 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14368 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370wait_end : boolean
14371 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14372 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14373 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14374 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14375 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14376 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14377 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14378 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380 Examples :
14381 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14382 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14383 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14386 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14387 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14388 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14389 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14390 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14391 tcp-request content reject
14392
14393
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143947.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395--------------------------------------
14396
14397It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14398This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14399data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14400its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14401HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14402content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14403to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14404more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14405response are indexed.
14406
14407base : string
14408 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14409 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14410 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14411 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14412 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14413 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14414 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14415 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14416
14417 ACL derivatives :
14418 base : exact string match
14419 base_beg : prefix match
14420 base_dir : subdir match
14421 base_dom : domain match
14422 base_end : suffix match
14423 base_len : length match
14424 base_reg : regex match
14425 base_sub : substring match
14426
14427base32 : integer
14428 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14429 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14430 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014431 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14432 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14433 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434
14435base32+src : binary
14436 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14437 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14438 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14439 per-URL counters.
14440
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014441capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14442 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14443 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14444 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14445
14446capture.req.method : string
14447 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14448 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14449 because it's allocated.
14450
14451capture.req.uri : string
14452 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14453 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14454 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14455 allocated.
14456
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014457capture.req.ver : string
14458 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14459 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14460 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14461
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014462capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14463 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14464 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14465 The first entry is an index of 0.
14466 See also: "capture response header"
14467
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014468capture.res.ver : string
14469 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14470 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14471 persistent flag.
14472
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014473req.body : binary
14474 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14475 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14476 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14477 the first chunk is analyzed.
14478
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014479req.body_param([<name>) : string
14480 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14481 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14482 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14483 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14484 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14485 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14486 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14487 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14488 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14489 given.
14490
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014491req.body_len : integer
14492 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14493 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14494 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14495 "option http-buffer-request".
14496
14497req.body_size : integer
14498 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14499 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14500 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14501 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14502 "option http-buffer-request".
14503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504req.cook([<name>]) : string
14505cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14506 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14507 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14508 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14509 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14510 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14511 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14512 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14513 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14514
14515 ACL derivatives :
14516 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14517 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14518 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14519 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14520 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14521 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14522 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14523 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14526cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14527 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14528 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14531cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14532 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14533 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14534 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14535 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14538 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14539 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14540 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14541 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014542 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14544 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14545 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14546 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14549 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14550 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14551 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14552 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014553 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14556 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14557 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14558 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14559 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14560 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14561 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14562 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14563 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14566 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14567 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14568 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14569 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14573 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14574 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14575 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14576 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14577 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14578 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14579 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14580 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14581 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14582 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584 ACL derivatives :
14585 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14586 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14587 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14588 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14589 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14590 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14591 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14592 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14593
14594req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14595hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14596 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14597 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14598 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14599 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14600 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14601 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14602 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14603 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14604 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14605
14606req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14607hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14608 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14609 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14610 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14611 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14612 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14613 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14614 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14615 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14616
14617req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14618hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14619 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14620 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14621 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14622 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14623 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14624 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14625 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14626
14627http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14628 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14629 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14630 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14631 basic auth is supported.
14632
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014633http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14634 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14635 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14636 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14637 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14639 basic auth is supported.
14640
14641 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014642 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14643 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14644 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14645 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646
14647http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014648 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14649 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14651 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653method : integer + string
14654 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14655 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14656 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14657 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14658 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14659 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14660 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662 ACL derivatives :
14663 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014665 Example :
14666 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14667 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14668 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670path : string
14671 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14672 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14673 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14674 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14675 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14676 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14677 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679 ACL derivatives :
14680 path : exact string match
14681 path_beg : prefix match
14682 path_dir : subdir match
14683 path_dom : domain match
14684 path_end : suffix match
14685 path_len : length match
14686 path_reg : regex match
14687 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014688
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014689query : string
14690 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14691 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14692 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14693 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014694 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014695 which stops before the question mark.
14696
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014697req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14698 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14699 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14700 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14701 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703req.ver : string
14704req_ver : string (deprecated)
14705 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14706 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14707 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709 ACL derivatives :
14710 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712res.comp : boolean
14713 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14714 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14715 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717res.comp_algo : string
14718 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14719 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14720 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722res.cook([<name>]) : string
14723scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14724 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14725 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14726 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014728 ACL derivatives :
14729 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14732scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14733 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14734 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14735 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14738scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14739 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14740 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14741 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14744 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14745 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14746 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14747 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14748 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14749 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14750 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14751 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14752 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14755 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14756 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14757 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14758 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14759 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14762shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14763 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14764 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14765 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14766 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14767 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14768 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14769 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14770 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772 ACL derivatives :
14773 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14774 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14775 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14776 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14777 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14778 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14779 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14780 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14781
14782res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14783shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14784 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14785 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14786 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14787 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14788 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14791shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14792 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14793 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14794 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14795 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14796 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14797 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014798
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014799res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14800 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14801 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14802 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14803 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14806shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14807 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14808 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14809 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14810 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14811 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14812 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814res.ver : string
14815resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14816 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14817 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 ACL derivatives :
14820 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14823 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14824 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014825 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14829 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831status : integer
14832 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14833 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14834 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014835
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014836unique-id : string
14837 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14838 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14839 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14840 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14841 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14842 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844url : string
14845 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14846 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14847 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14848 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14849 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14850 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14851 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853 ACL derivatives :
14854 url : exact string match
14855 url_beg : prefix match
14856 url_dir : subdir match
14857 url_dom : domain match
14858 url_end : suffix match
14859 url_len : length match
14860 url_reg : regex match
14861 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863url_ip : ip
14864 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14865 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14866 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14867 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14868 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14869 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14870 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872url_port : integer
14873 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14874 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14875 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14876 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014877
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014878urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14879url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14881 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014882 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14883 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14884 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14885 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14887 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014888 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14889 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891 ACL derivatives :
14892 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14893 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14894 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14895 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14896 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14897 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14898 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14899 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014900
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 Example :
14903 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14904 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14905 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14906 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014907
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014908urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014909 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14910 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14911 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014912
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014913url32 : integer
14914 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14915 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14916 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14917 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14918 is an unsigned integer.
14919
14920url32+src : binary
14921 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14922 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14923 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14924
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149267.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014927---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014929Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14930every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014931order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014933ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14934---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014935FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014936HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014937HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14938HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014939HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14940HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14941HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14942HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14943LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014944METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014945METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014946METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14947METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14948METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14949METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014950METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014951METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014952RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014953REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014954TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014955WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14956---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014957
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149598. Logging
14960----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014961
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014962One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14963provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14964very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14965provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14966state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014967to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014968headers.
14969
14970In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14971about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14972send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14973
14974 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14975 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14976 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14977 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14978 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014979 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14980 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014981
14982The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14983allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14984as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14985while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14986real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14987delay.
14988
14989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149908.1. Log levels
14991---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014992
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014993TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014994source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014995HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14996in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14997track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14998syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14999about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015000
15001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150028.2. Log formats
15003----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015004
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015005HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015006and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15007slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15008options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015009
15010 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15011 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15012 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15013 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15014 extents.
15015
15016 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15017 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15018 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15019 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15020 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15021
15022 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15023 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15024 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15025 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15026 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15027
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015028 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15029 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15030 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15031 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015033 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015035Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15036specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15037field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15038servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15039always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15040identifier.
15041
15042Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15043 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15044 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15045 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15046 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15047
15048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150498.2.1. Default log format
15050-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015051
15052This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15053as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15054format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15055
15056 Example :
15057 listen www
15058 mode http
15059 log global
15060 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15061
15062 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15063 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15064 (www/HTTP)
15065
15066 Field Format Extract from the example above
15067 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15068 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15069 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15070 4 'to' to
15071 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15072 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15073
15074Detailed fields description :
15075 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15076 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15077 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15078 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15079 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15080 and processed the connection.
15081 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15082
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015083In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15084"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15085connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015087It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15088will eventually disappear.
15089
15090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150918.2.2. TCP log format
15092---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015093
15094The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15095is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15096information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15097counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15098emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15099environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15100the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15101sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015102specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15103not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15104fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15105marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015106
15107 Example :
15108 frontend fnt
15109 mode tcp
15110 option tcplog
15111 log global
15112 default_backend bck
15113
15114 backend bck
15115 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15116
15117 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15118 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15119 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15120
15121 Field Format Extract from the example above
15122 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15123 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15124 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15125 4 frontend_name fnt
15126 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15127 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15128 7 bytes_read* 212
15129 8 termination_state --
15130 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15131 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15132
15133Detailed fields description :
15134 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015135 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15136 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15137 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015138 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15139 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15140 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015141
15142 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015143 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15144 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15145 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015146
15147 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15148 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15149 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15150 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15151
15152 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15153 and processed the connection.
15154
15155 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15156 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15157 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15158 applications.
15159
15160 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15161 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15162 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15163 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15164 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15165
15166 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15167 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15168 See "Timers" below for more details.
15169
15170 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15171 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15172 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15173 "Timers" below for more details.
15174
15175 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015176 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015177 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15178 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15179 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15180 details.
15181
15182 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15183 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15184 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15185 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15186 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15187
15188 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15189 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15190 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15191 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15192 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15193 for more details.
15194
15195 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015196 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015197 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15198 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15199 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015200 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015201
15202 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15203 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15204 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15205 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15206 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15207 caused by a denial of service attack.
15208
15209 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15210 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15211 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15212 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15213 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15214 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15215 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15216 denial of service attack.
15217
15218 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15219 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15220 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15221 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15222 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15223 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15224 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15225 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15226 be processed than on other servers.
15227
15228 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15229 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15230 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15231 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15232 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15233 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15234 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15235 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15236 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15237 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15238 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15239 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15240 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15241
15242 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15243 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15244 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15245 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15246 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15247 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15248 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15249 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15250
15251 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15252 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15253 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15254 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15255 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15256 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15257 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15258 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15259 occurs.
15260
15261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152628.2.3. HTTP log format
15263----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264
15265The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15266is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15267the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15268are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15269emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15270generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15271"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15272which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015273frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15274is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015275
15276Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15277slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15278with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15279
15280 Example :
15281 frontend http-in
15282 mode http
15283 option httplog
15284 log global
15285 default_backend bck
15286
15287 backend static
15288 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15289
15290 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15291 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15292 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015293 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015294
15295 Field Format Extract from the example above
15296 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15297 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015298 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015299 4 frontend_name http-in
15300 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015301 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015302 7 status_code 200
15303 8 bytes_read* 2750
15304 9 captured_request_cookie -
15305 10 captured_response_cookie -
15306 11 termination_state ----
15307 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15308 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15309 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15310 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15311 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015313Detailed fields description :
15314 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015315 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15316 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15317 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015318 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15319 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15320 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015321
15322 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015323 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15324 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15325 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015326
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015327 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15328 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015329
15330 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15331 and processed the connection.
15332
15333 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15334 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15335 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15336
15337 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15338 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15339 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15340 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15341 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15342 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015344 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15345 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15346 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15347 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15348 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15349 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15350 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351
15352 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15353 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15354 See "Timers" below for more details.
15355
15356 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15357 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15358 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15359 below for more details.
15360
15361 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15362 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15363 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15364 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15365 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15366 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15367 for more details.
15368
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015369 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15370 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15371 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15372 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15373 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15374 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15375 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15376 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015377
15378 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15379 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15380 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15381
15382 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15383 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15384 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15385 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15386 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15387 overflowing.
15388
15389 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15390 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15391 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15392 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15393 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15394 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15395 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15396 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15397
15398 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15399 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15400 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15401 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15402 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15403 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15404 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15405 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15406
15407 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15408 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15409 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15410 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15411 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15412 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15413 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15414
15415 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015416 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015417 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15418 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15419 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015420 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015421 system.
15422
15423 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15424 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15425 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15426 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15427 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15428 caused by a denial of service attack.
15429
15430 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15431 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15432 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15433 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15434 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15435 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15436 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15437 denial of service attack.
15438
15439 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15440 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15441 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15442 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15443 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15444 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15445 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15446 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15447 processed than on other servers.
15448
15449 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15450 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15451 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15452 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15453 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15454 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15455 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15456 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15457 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15458 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15459 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15460 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15461 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15462
15463 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15464 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15465 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15466 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15467 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15468 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15469 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15470 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15471
15472 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15473 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15474 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15475 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15476 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15477 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15478 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15479 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15480 occurs.
15481
15482 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15483 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15484 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15485 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15486 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15487 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15488 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15489 cookies" below for more details.
15490
15491 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15492 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15493 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15494 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15495 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15496 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15497 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15498 and cookies" below for more details.
15499
15500 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15501 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15502 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15503 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15504 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15505 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15506 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15507 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15508
15509
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200155108.2.4. Custom log format
15511------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015512
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015513The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015514mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015515
15516HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15517Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15518separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15519prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15520
15521Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15522variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015523("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015524
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015525If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015526as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015527less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15528the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15529
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015530Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015531In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015532in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015533
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015534Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15535'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15536https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15537such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15538
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015539Flags are :
15540 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015541 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015542 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15543 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015544
15545 Example:
15546
15547 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15548 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15549
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015550 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15551
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015552At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15553
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015554 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15555 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015556
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015557the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015558
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015559 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15560 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15561 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015562
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015563and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15564
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015565 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15566 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015567
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015568Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15569
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015570 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015571 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015572 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15573 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15574 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015575 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15576 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15577 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015578 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015579 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15580 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015581 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015582 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15583 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015584 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015585 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015586 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015587 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015588 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015589 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015590 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015591 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15592 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15593 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15594 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15595 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015596 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015597 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15598 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015599 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015600 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15601 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015602 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15603 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15604 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015605 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015606 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15607 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015608 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015609 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15610 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15611 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015612 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015613 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015614 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15615 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15616 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15617 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015618 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015619 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015620 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015621 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015622 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015623 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015624 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15625 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15626 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015627 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015628 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15629 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015630 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015631 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15632 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15633 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015634 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015635 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015636 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015637
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015638 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015639
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015640
156418.2.5. Error log format
15642-----------------------
15643
15644When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15645protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15646By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15647"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15648will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15649logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15650
15651The format looks like this :
15652
15653 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15654 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15655 Connection error during SSL handshake
15656
15657 Field Format Extract from the example above
15658 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15659 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15660 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15661 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15662 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15663
15664These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15665failures.
15666
15667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156688.3. Advanced logging options
15669-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015670
15671Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15672just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15673options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15674for more information about their usage.
15675
15676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15678------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015679
15680It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15681haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15682commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15683monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15684ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15685
15686 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15687 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15688 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15689 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15690
15691 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15692 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15693 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015694 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015695 such as other load-balancers.
15696
15697 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15698 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15699 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15700
15701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15703----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015704
15705The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15706what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15707or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15708"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15709just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15710log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15711after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15712is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15713with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15714with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15715
15716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15718------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015719
15720Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15721for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15722"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15723retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15724raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15725a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15726file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15727you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15728"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15729
15730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15732--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015733
15734Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15735multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15736them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15737"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15738logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15739error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15740and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15741too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15742useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15743alternative.
15744
15745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157468.4. Timing events
15747------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015748
15749Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15750reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15751the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15752frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015753mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15754addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15755
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015756Timings events in HTTP mode:
15757
15758 first request 2nd request
15759 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15760 t tr t tr ...
15761 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15762 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15763 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15764 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15765 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15766
15767Timings events in TCP mode:
15768
15769 TCP session
15770 |<----------------->|
15771 t t
15772 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15773 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15774 |<------ Tt ------->|
15775
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015776 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15777 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15778 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15779 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15780 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15781 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15782 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015783
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015784 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15785 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15786 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15787 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15788 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15789 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15790 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15791 nothing was received on the connection.
15792
15793 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15794 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15795 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15796 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15797 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15798 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15799 request typed by hand during a test.
15800
15801 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15802 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15803 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15804 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15805 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15806 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15807 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015808
15809 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15810 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15811 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15812 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15813 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15814
15815 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15816 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15817 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15818 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15819 connection never established.
15820
15821 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15822 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15823 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15824 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15825 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15826 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15827 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15828 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15829 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15830 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15831 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15832
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015833 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15834 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15835 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15836 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15837 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15838 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15839
15840 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15841
15842 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15843 "Ta" can never be negative.
15844
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015845 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15846 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015847 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15848 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015849 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015851 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015852
15853 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015854 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15855 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015856
15857These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15858protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15859that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015860due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15861"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15862that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015863
15864Most common cases :
15865
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015866 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15867 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15868 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15869 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15870 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15871 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15872 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15873 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15874 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15875 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15876 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015877 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015878
15879 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15880 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15881 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15882 of ms on remote networks.
15883
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015884 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15885 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15886 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015887
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015888 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15889 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15890 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15891 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15892 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15893 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15894 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15895 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15896 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015897
15898Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015900 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015901 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015902 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015903
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015904 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015905 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15906 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15907
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015908 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015909 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15910 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15911 flags.
15912
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015913 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15914 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015915 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15916 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15917 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15918 the client connection was maintained open.
15919
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015920 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015921 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015922 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015923 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15924
15925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159268.5. Session state at disconnection
15927-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015928
15929TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15930"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
159312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15932each of which has a special meaning :
15933
15934 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15935 session to terminate :
15936
15937 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15938
15939 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15940 server explicitly refused it.
15941
15942 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15943 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15944 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15945 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015946 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15947
15948 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15949 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015950
15951 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15952 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15953 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15954 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15955 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15956
15957 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15958 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15959 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15960 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15961 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15962
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015963 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15964 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15965
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015966 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15967 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15968 backup connections when going up.
15969
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015970 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015972 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15973 send or receive data.
15974
15975 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15976 send or receive data.
15977
15978 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15979 with nothing left in the buffers.
15980
15981 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15982
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015983 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015984 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15985
15986 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15987 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15988 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15989 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15990 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15991
15992 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15993 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15994
15995 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15996 server (HTTP only).
15997
15998 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15999
16000 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16001 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16002 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16003
16004 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16005 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16006 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16007
16008 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16009
16010 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16011 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16012
16013 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16014 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16015 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16016
16017 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16018 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016019 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16020 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016021
16022 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16023 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16024 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16025 another server.
16026
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016027 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016028 server.
16029
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016030 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16031 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16032 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16033 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16034
16035 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16036 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16037 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16038 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16039
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016040 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16041 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16042 "use-server" rule).
16043
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016044 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16045
16046 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16047 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16048
16049 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16050
16051 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16052 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16053 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16054
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016055 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16056 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016057 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016058 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16059 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16060
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016061 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16062
16063 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16064 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16065
16066 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16067
16068 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16069
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016070The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16071was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016072helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16073starvation, attacks, etc...
16074
16075The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16076alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16077easier finding and understanding.
16078
16079 Flags Reason
16080
16081 -- Normal termination.
16082
16083 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16084 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16085 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16086 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16087
16088 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16089 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16090 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16091 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16092 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16093 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016094
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016095 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16096 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016097 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016098
16099 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16100 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16101 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16102
16103 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16104 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16105 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16106 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16107 the server takes too long to respond.
16108
16109 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16110 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16111 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16112 long a time to respond.
16113
16114 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16115 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16116 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16117 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016118 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16119 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016120
16121 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16122 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16123 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16124 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16125 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016126 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016127 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16128 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16129 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16130 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16131 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16132 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16133 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16134 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16135 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16136 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16137 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16138 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016139
16140 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16141 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016142 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16143 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16144 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16145 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016146
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016147 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16148 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016150 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016151 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16152 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16153 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16154 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16155 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16156
16157 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16158 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16159 503 or 504 here.
16160
16161 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16162 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16163 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16164 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16165 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16166
16167 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16168 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016169 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016170 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16171 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16172
16173 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16174 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16175 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16176 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16177 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16178 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16179 between haproxy and the server.
16180
16181 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16182 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16183 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16184 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16185 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16186 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16187 solution is to fix the application.
16188
16189 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16190 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16191 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16192 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16193 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16194 external attacks.
16195
16196 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16197 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016198 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016199 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16200 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16201
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016202 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16203 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16204 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016205 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16206 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016208 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16209 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16210 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16211 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016212 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16213 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16214 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16215 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16216 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217
16218 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16219 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16220 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16221 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16222
16223 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16224 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16225 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16226 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16227
16228 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16229 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16230 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16231 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16232
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016233The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16234persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16235important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16236re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16237
16238 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16239
16240 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16241 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16242 set on a GET request.
16243
16244 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16245 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016246 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016247 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16248
16249 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16250 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16251 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16252
16253 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16254 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16255 already got a cookie.
16256
16257 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16258 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16259 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16260 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16261 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16262
16263 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16264 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16265 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16266
16267 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16268 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16269 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16270
16271 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16272 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16273
16274 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16275 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16276 then advertised in the response.
16277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162798.6. Non-printable characters
16280-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016281
16282In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16283consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16284converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16285prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16286being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16287escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16288is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16289'}' when logging headers.
16290
16291Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16292issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16293containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16294
16295Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16296the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16297performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16298
16299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16301---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016302
16303Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16304achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016306cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16307the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16308the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016309locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016310not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16311user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16312a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16313wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16314
16315 Examples :
16316 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16317 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16318
16319 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16320 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16321
16322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16324---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016325
16326Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16327proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16328the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16329server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16330
16331Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16332response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016333section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016334
16335It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016336time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16337appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16339and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16340follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16341request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16342in the logs.
16343
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016344As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16345frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16346an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16347
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016348 Example :
16349 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16350 listen proxy-out
16351 mode http
16352 option httplog
16353 option logasap
16354 log global
16355 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16356
16357 # log the name of the virtual server
16358 capture request header Host len 20
16359
16360 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16361 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16362
16363 # log the beginning of the referrer
16364 capture request header Referer len 20
16365
16366 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16367 capture response header Server len 20
16368
16369 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16370 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16371
16372 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16373 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16374
16375 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16376 capture response header Via len 20
16377
16378 # log the URL location during a redirection
16379 capture response header Location len 20
16380
16381 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16382 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16383 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16384 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16385 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16386
16387 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16388 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16389 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16390 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016391 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016392
16393 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16394 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16395 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16396 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16397 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016398 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016399
16400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164018.9. Examples of logs
16402---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016403
16404These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16405them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16406reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16407
16408 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16409 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16410 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16411
16412 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16413 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16414
16415 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16416 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16417 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16418
16419 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16420 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16421
16422 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16423 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16424 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16425
16426 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016427 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016428 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16429 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16430
16431 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16432 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16433 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16434
16435 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16436 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016437 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016438 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16439 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16440 to return the 502 and not the server.
16441
16442 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016443 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016444
16445 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16446 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16447 Nothing was sent to any server.
16448
16449 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16450 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16451
16452 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16453 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16454 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16455 send a 408 return code to the client.
16456
16457 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16458 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16459
16460 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16461 5 seconds ("c----").
16462
16463 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16464 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016465 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016466
16467 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016468 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016469 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16470 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16471 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16472 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16473 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016474
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016475
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200164769. Supported filters
16477--------------------
16478
16479Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16480accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16481unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16482
16483See also : "filter"
16484
164859.1. Trace
16486----------
16487
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016488filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016489
16490 Arguments:
16491 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16492 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16493
16494 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16495 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16496 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16497 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16498
16499 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16500 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16501 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16502 amount of the parsed data.
16503
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016504 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16505
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016506This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16507callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16508information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16509filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16510
16511Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16512tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16513a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16514
16515
165169.2. HTTP compression
16517---------------------
16518
16519filter compression
16520
16521The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16522keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16523when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16524use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16525used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16526filters evaluation order.
16527
16528See also : "compression"
16529
16530
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200165319.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16532--------------------------------------------
16533
16534filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16535
16536 Arguments :
16537
16538 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16539 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16540 parsed.
16541
16542 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16543 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16544 part must be placed in its own scope.
16545
16546The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16547external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16548streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16549exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16550also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16551
16552SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16553the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16554
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016555For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016556"doc/SPOE.txt".
16557
16558Important note:
16559 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16560 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016562/*
16563 * Local variables:
16564 * fill-column: 79
16565 * End:
16566 */